1  #ifndef __LINUX_NL80211_H
2  #define __LINUX_NL80211_H
3  /*
4   * 802.11 netlink interface public header
5   *
6   * Copyright 2006-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
7   * Copyright 2008 Michael Wu <flamingice@sourmilk.net>
8   * Copyright 2008 Luis Carlos Cobo <luisca@cozybit.com>
9   * Copyright 2008 Michael Buesch <m@bues.ch>
10   * Copyright 2008, 2009 Luis R. Rodriguez <lrodriguez@atheros.com>
11   * Copyright 2008 Jouni Malinen <jouni.malinen@atheros.com>
12   * Copyright 2008 Colin McCabe <colin@cozybit.com>
13   * Copyright 2015-2017	Intel Deutschland GmbH
14   * Copyright (C) 2018-2024 Intel Corporation
15   *
16   * Permission to use, copy, modify, and/or distribute this software for any
17   * purpose with or without fee is hereby granted, provided that the above
18   * copyright notice and this permission notice appear in all copies.
19   *
20   * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS" AND THE AUTHOR DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES
21   * WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
22   * MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR
23   * ANY SPECIAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
24   * WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN
25   * ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING OUT OF
26   * OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
27   *
28   */
29  
30  /*
31   * This header file defines the userspace API to the wireless stack. Please
32   * be careful not to break things - i.e. don't move anything around or so
33   * unless you can demonstrate that it breaks neither API nor ABI.
34   *
35   * Additions to the API should be accompanied by actual implementations in
36   * an upstream driver, so that example implementations exist in case there
37   * are ever concerns about the precise semantics of the API or changes are
38   * needed, and to ensure that code for dead (no longer implemented) API
39   * can actually be identified and removed.
40   * Nonetheless, semantics should also be documented carefully in this file.
41   */
42  
43  #include <linux/types.h>
44  
45  #define NL80211_GENL_NAME "nl80211"
46  
47  #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_CONFIG		"config"
48  #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_SCAN		"scan"
49  #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_REG		"regulatory"
50  #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_MLME		"mlme"
51  #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_VENDOR		"vendor"
52  #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_NAN		"nan"
53  #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_TESTMODE	"testmode"
54  
55  #define NL80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_MIN	4
56  #define NL80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_MAX	15
57  #define NL80211_EDMG_CHANNELS_MIN	1
58  #define NL80211_EDMG_CHANNELS_MAX	0x3c /* 0b00111100 */
59  
60  /**
61   * DOC: Station handling
62   *
63   * Stations are added per interface, but a special case exists with VLAN
64   * interfaces. When a station is bound to an AP interface, it may be moved
65   * into a VLAN identified by a VLAN interface index (%NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN).
66   * The station is still assumed to belong to the AP interface it was added
67   * to.
68   *
69   * Station handling varies per interface type and depending on the driver's
70   * capabilities.
71   *
72   * For drivers supporting TDLS with external setup (WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS
73   * and WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP), the station lifetime is as follows:
74   *  - a setup station entry is added, not yet authorized, without any rate
75   *    or capability information; this just exists to avoid race conditions
76   *  - when the TDLS setup is done, a single NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION is valid
77   *    to add rate and capability information to the station and at the same
78   *    time mark it authorized.
79   *  - %NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK is then used
80   *  - after this, the only valid operation is to remove it by tearing down
81   *    the TDLS link (%NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK)
82   *
83   * TODO: need more info for other interface types
84   */
85  
86  /**
87   * DOC: Frame transmission/registration support
88   *
89   * Frame transmission and registration support exists to allow userspace
90   * management entities such as wpa_supplicant to react to management frames
91   * that are not being handled by the kernel. This includes, for example,
92   * certain classes of action frames that cannot be handled in the kernel
93   * for various reasons.
94   *
95   * Frame registration is done on a per-interface basis and registrations
96   * cannot be removed other than by closing the socket. It is possible to
97   * specify a registration filter to register, for example, only for a
98   * certain type of action frame. In particular with action frames, those
99   * that userspace registers for will not be returned as unhandled by the
100   * driver, so that the registered application has to take responsibility
101   * for doing that.
102   *
103   * The type of frame that can be registered for is also dependent on the
104   * driver and interface type. The frame types are advertised in wiphy
105   * attributes so applications know what to expect.
106   *
107   * NOTE: When an interface changes type while registrations are active,
108   *       these registrations are ignored until the interface type is
109   *       changed again. This means that changing the interface type can
110   *       lead to a situation that couldn't otherwise be produced, but
111   *       any such registrations will be dormant in the sense that they
112   *       will not be serviced, i.e. they will not receive any frames.
113   *
114   * Frame transmission allows userspace to send for example the required
115   * responses to action frames. It is subject to some sanity checking,
116   * but many frames can be transmitted. When a frame is transmitted, its
117   * status is indicated to the sending socket.
118   *
119   * For more technical details, see the corresponding command descriptions
120   * below.
121   */
122  
123  /**
124   * DOC: Virtual interface / concurrency capabilities
125   *
126   * Some devices are able to operate with virtual MACs; they can have
127   * more than one virtual interface. The capability handling for this
128   * is a bit complex though, as there may be a number of restrictions
129   * on the types of concurrency that are supported.
130   *
131   * To start with, each device supports the interface types listed in
132   * the %NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES attribute, but by listing the
133   * types there no concurrency is implied.
134   *
135   * Once concurrency is desired, more attributes must be observed:
136   * To start with, since some interface types are purely managed in
137   * software, like the AP-VLAN type in mac80211 for example, there's
138   * an additional list of these; they can be added at any time and
139   * are only restricted by some semantic restrictions (e.g. AP-VLAN
140   * cannot be added without a corresponding AP interface). This list
141   * is exported in the %NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES attribute.
142   *
143   * Further, the list of supported combinations is exported. This is
144   * in the %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS attribute. Basically,
145   * it exports a list of "groups", and at any point in time the
146   * interfaces that are currently active must fall into any one of
147   * the advertised groups. Within each group, there are restrictions
148   * on the number of interfaces of different types that are supported
149   * and also the number of different channels, along with potentially
150   * some other restrictions. See &enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs.
151   *
152   * All together, these attributes define the concurrency of virtual
153   * interfaces that a given device supports.
154   */
155  
156  /**
157   * DOC: packet coalesce support
158   *
159   * In most cases, host that receives IPv4 and IPv6 multicast/broadcast
160   * packets does not do anything with these packets. Therefore the
161   * reception of these unwanted packets causes unnecessary processing
162   * and power consumption.
163   *
164   * Packet coalesce feature helps to reduce number of received interrupts
165   * to host by buffering these packets in firmware/hardware for some
166   * predefined time. Received interrupt will be generated when one of the
167   * following events occurs.
168   * a) Expiration of hardware timer whose expiration time is set to maximum
169   * coalescing delay of matching coalesce rule.
170   * b) Coalescing buffer in hardware reaches its limit.
171   * c) Packet doesn't match any of the configured coalesce rules.
172   *
173   * User needs to configure following parameters for creating a coalesce
174   * rule.
175   * a) Maximum coalescing delay
176   * b) List of packet patterns which needs to be matched
177   * c) Condition for coalescence: pattern 'match' or 'no match'
178   * Multiple such rules can be created.
179   */
180  
181  /**
182   * DOC: WPA/WPA2 EAPOL handshake offload
183   *
184   * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK flag drivers
185   * can indicate they support offloading EAPOL handshakes for WPA/WPA2
186   * preshared key authentication in station mode. In %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
187   * the preshared key should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_PMK. Drivers
188   * supporting this offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT when no
189   * preshared key material is provided, for example when that driver does
190   * not support setting the temporal keys through %NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY.
191   *
192   * Similarly @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X flag can be
193   * set by drivers indicating offload support of the PTK/GTK EAPOL
194   * handshakes during 802.1X authentication in station mode. In order to
195   * use the offload the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT should have
196   * %NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS attribute flag. Drivers supporting this
197   * offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT when the attribute flag is
198   * not present.
199   *
200   * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_AP_PSK flag drivers
201   * can indicate they support offloading EAPOL handshakes for WPA/WPA2
202   * preshared key authentication in AP mode. In %NL80211_CMD_START_AP
203   * the preshared key should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_PMK. Drivers
204   * supporting this offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_START_AP when no
205   * preshared key material is provided, for example when that driver does
206   * not support setting the temporal keys through %NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY.
207   *
208   * For 802.1X the PMK or PMK-R0 are set by providing %NL80211_ATTR_PMK
209   * using %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK. For offloaded FT support also
210   * %NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME must be provided.
211   */
212  
213  /**
214   * DOC: FILS shared key authentication offload
215   *
216   * FILS shared key authentication offload can be advertised by drivers by
217   * setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD flag. The drivers that support
218   * FILS shared key authentication offload should be able to construct the
219   * authentication and association frames for FILS shared key authentication and
220   * eventually do a key derivation as per IEEE 802.11ai. The below additional
221   * parameters should be given to driver in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and/or in
222   * %NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS.
223   *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME - used to construct keyname_nai
224   *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM - used to construct keyname_nai
225   *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM - used to construct erp message
226   *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK - used to generate the rIK and rMSK
227   * rIK should be used to generate an authentication tag on the ERP message and
228   * rMSK should be used to derive a PMKSA.
229   * rIK, rMSK should be generated and keyname_nai, sequence number should be used
230   * as specified in IETF RFC 6696.
231   *
232   * When FILS shared key authentication is completed, driver needs to provide the
233   * below additional parameters to userspace, which can be either after setting
234   * up a connection or after roaming.
235   *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK - used for key renewal
236   *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM - used in further EAP-RP exchanges
237   *	%NL80211_ATTR_PMKID - used to identify the PMKSA used/generated
238   *	%Nl80211_ATTR_PMK - used to update PMKSA cache in userspace
239   * The PMKSA can be maintained in userspace persistently so that it can be used
240   * later after reboots or wifi turn off/on also.
241   *
242   * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID is the cache identifier advertised by a FILS
243   * capable AP supporting PMK caching. It specifies the scope within which the
244   * PMKSAs are cached in an ESS. %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA and
245   * %NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA are enhanced to allow support for PMKSA caching based
246   * on FILS cache identifier. Additionally %NL80211_ATTR_PMK is used with
247   * %NL80211_SET_PMKSA to specify the PMK corresponding to a PMKSA for driver to
248   * use in a FILS shared key connection with PMKSA caching.
249   */
250  
251  /**
252   * DOC: SAE authentication offload
253   *
254   * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD flag drivers can indicate they
255   * support offloading SAE authentication for WPA3-Personal networks in station
256   * mode. Similarly @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD_AP flag can be set by
257   * drivers indicating the offload support in AP mode.
258   *
259   * The password for SAE should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD in
260   * %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and %NL80211_CMD_START_AP for station and AP mode
261   * respectively.
262   */
263  
264  /**
265   * DOC: VLAN offload support for setting group keys and binding STAs to VLANs
266   *
267   * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD flag drivers can indicate they
268   * support offloading VLAN functionality in a manner where the driver exposes a
269   * single netdev that uses VLAN tagged frames and separate VLAN-specific netdevs
270   * can then be added using RTM_NEWLINK/IFLA_VLAN_ID similarly to the Ethernet
271   * case. Frames received from stations that are not assigned to any VLAN are
272   * delivered on the main netdev and frames to such stations can be sent through
273   * that main netdev.
274   *
275   * %NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY (for group keys), %NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION, and
276   * %NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION will optionally specify vlan_id using
277   * %NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID.
278   */
279  
280  /**
281   * DOC: TID configuration
282   *
283   * TID config support can be checked in the %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG
284   * attribute given in wiphy capabilities.
285   *
286   * The necessary configuration parameters are mentioned in
287   * &enum nl80211_tid_config_attr and it will be passed to the
288   * %NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG command in %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG.
289   *
290   * If the configuration needs to be applied for specific peer then the MAC
291   * address of the peer needs to be passed in %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, otherwise the
292   * configuration will be applied for all the connected peers in the vif except
293   * any peers that have peer-specific configuration for the TID by default; if
294   * the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE flag is set, peer-specific values
295   * will be overwritten.
296   *
297   * All this configuration is valid only for STA's current connection,
298   * i.e., the configuration will be reset to default when the STA connects back
299   * after disconnection/roaming, and this configuration will be cleared when
300   * the interface goes down.
301   */
302  
303  /**
304   * DOC: FILS shared key crypto offload
305   *
306   * This feature is applicable to drivers running in AP mode.
307   *
308   * FILS shared key crypto offload can be advertised by drivers by setting
309   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_CRYPTO_OFFLOAD flag. The drivers that support
310   * FILS shared key crypto offload should be able to encrypt and decrypt
311   * association frames for FILS shared key authentication as per IEEE 802.11ai.
312   * With this capability, for FILS key derivation, drivers depend on userspace.
313   *
314   * After FILS key derivation, userspace shares the FILS AAD details with the
315   * driver and the driver stores the same to use in decryption of association
316   * request and in encryption of association response. The below parameters
317   * should be given to the driver in %NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD.
318   *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC - STA MAC address, used for storing FILS AAD per STA
319   *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK - Used for encryption or decryption
320   *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES - Used for encryption or decryption
321   *			(STA Nonce 16 bytes followed by AP Nonce 16 bytes)
322   *
323   * Once the association is done, the driver cleans the FILS AAD data.
324   */
325  
326  /**
327   * DOC: Multi-Link Operation
328   *
329   * In Multi-Link Operation, a connection between two MLDs utilizes multiple
330   * links. To use this in nl80211, various commands and responses now need
331   * to or will include the new %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS attribute.
332   * Additionally, various commands that need to operate on a specific link
333   * now need to be given the %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID attribute, e.g. to
334   * use %NL80211_CMD_START_AP or similar functions.
335   */
336  
337  /**
338   * DOC: OWE DH IE handling offload
339   *
340   * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD flag, drivers can indicate
341   * kernel/application space to avoid DH IE handling. When this flag is
342   * advertised, the driver/device will take care of DH IE inclusion and
343   * processing of peer DH IE to generate PMK.
344   */
345  
346  /**
347   * enum nl80211_commands - supported nl80211 commands
348   *
349   * @NL80211_CMD_UNSPEC: unspecified command to catch errors
350   *
351   * @NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY: request information about a wiphy or dump request
352   *	to get a list of all present wiphys.
353   * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY: set wiphy parameters, needs %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY or
354   *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX; can be used to set %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME,
355   *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ,
356   *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET (and the attributes determining the
357   *	channel width; this is used for setting monitor mode channel),
358   *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG,
359   *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD, and/or
360   *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD.  However, for setting the channel,
361   *	see %NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL instead, the support here is for backward
362   *	compatibility only.
363   * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_WIPHY: Newly created wiphy, response to get request
364   *	or rename notification. Has attributes %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and
365   *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME.
366   * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_WIPHY: Wiphy deleted. Has attributes
367   *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME.
368   *
369   * @NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE: Request an interface's configuration;
370   *	either a dump request for all interfaces or a specific get with a
371   *	single %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is supported.
372   * @NL80211_CMD_SET_INTERFACE: Set type of a virtual interface, requires
373   *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE.
374   * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE: Newly created virtual interface or response
375   *	to %NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE. Has %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX,
376   *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE attributes. Can also
377   *	be sent from userspace to request creation of a new virtual interface,
378   *	then requires attributes %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY, %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE and
379   *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME.
380   * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_INTERFACE: Virtual interface was deleted, has attributes
381   *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY. Can also be sent from
382   *	userspace to request deletion of a virtual interface, then requires
383   *	attribute %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. If multiple BSSID advertisements are
384   *	enabled using %NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_CONFIG, %NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS,
385   *	and if this command is used for the transmitting interface, then all
386   *	the non-transmitting interfaces are deleted as well.
387   *
388   * @NL80211_CMD_GET_KEY: Get sequence counter information for a key specified
389   *	by %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX and/or %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
390   *	represents peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key. For MLO group key,
391   *	the link is identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID.
392   * @NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY: Set key attributes %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT,
393   *	%NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT, or %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_THRESHOLD.
394   *	For MLO connection, the link to set default key is identified by
395   *	%NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID.
396   * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY: add a key with given %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA,
397   *	%NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER,
398   *	and %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ attributes. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC represents
399   *	peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key. The link to add MLO
400   *	group key is identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID.
401   * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_KEY: delete a key identified by %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX
402   *	or %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC represents peer's MLD address
403   *	for MLO pairwise key. The link to delete group key is identified by
404   *	%NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID.
405   *
406   * @NL80211_CMD_GET_BEACON: (not used)
407   * @NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON: change the beacon on an access point interface
408   *	using the %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD and %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL
409   *	attributes. For drivers that generate the beacon and probe responses
410   *	internally, the following attributes must be provided: %NL80211_ATTR_IE,
411   *	%NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP and %NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP.
412   * @NL80211_CMD_START_AP: Start AP operation on an AP interface, parameters
413   *	are like for %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON, and additionally parameters that
414   *	do not change are used, these include %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL,
415   *	%NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD, %NL80211_ATTR_SSID,
416   *	%NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID, %NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE,
417   *	%NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP, %NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS,
418   *	%NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES, %NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY,
419   *	%NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE, %NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT,
420   *	%NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS.
421   *	The channel to use can be set on the interface or be given using the
422   *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET, and the
423   *	attributes determining channel width.
424   * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON: old alias for %NL80211_CMD_START_AP
425   * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP: Stop AP operation on the given interface
426   * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_BEACON: old alias for %NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP
427   *
428   * @NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION: Get station attributes for station identified by
429   *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
430   * @NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION: Set station attributes for station identified by
431   *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
432   * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION: Add a station with given attributes to the
433   *	interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
434   * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_STATION: Remove a station identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
435   *	or, if no MAC address given, all stations, on the interface identified
436   *	by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. For MLD station, MLD address is used in
437   *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC. %NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE and
438   *	%NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE can optionally be used to specify which type
439   *	of disconnection indication should be sent to the station
440   *	(Deauthentication or Disassociation frame and reason code for that
441   *	frame). %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID can be used optionally to remove
442   *	stations connected and using at least that link as one of its links.
443   *
444   * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH: Get mesh path attributes for mesh path to
445   *	destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by
446   *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
447   * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MPATH:  Set mesh path attributes for mesh path to
448   *	destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by
449   *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
450   * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_MPATH: Create a new mesh path for the destination given by
451   *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC via %NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP.
452   * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_MPATH: Delete a mesh path to the destination given by
453   *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC.
454   * @NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS: Set BSS attributes for BSS identified by
455   *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
456   *
457   * @NL80211_CMD_GET_REG: ask the wireless core to send us its currently set
458   *	regulatory domain. If %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY is specified and the device
459   *	has a private regulatory domain, it will be returned. Otherwise, the
460   *	global regdomain will be returned.
461   *	A device will have a private regulatory domain if it uses the
462   *	regulatory_hint() API. Even when a private regdomain is used the channel
463   *	information will still be mended according to further hints from
464   *	the regulatory core to help with compliance. A dump version of this API
465   *	is now available which will returns the global regdomain as well as
466   *	all private regdomains of present wiphys (for those that have it).
467   *	If a wiphy is self-managed (%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG), then
468   *	its private regdomain is the only valid one for it. The regulatory
469   *	core is not used to help with compliance in this case.
470   * @NL80211_CMD_SET_REG: Set current regulatory domain. CRDA sends this command
471   *	after being queried by the kernel. CRDA replies by sending a regulatory
472   *	domain structure which consists of %NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA set to our
473   *	current alpha2 if it found a match. It also provides
474   *	NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS, and a set of regulatory rules. Each
475   *	regulatory rule is a nested set of attributes  given by
476   *	%NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FREQ_[START|END] and
477   *	%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW with an attached power rule given by
478   *	%NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_POWER_MAX_ANT_GAIN and
479   *	%NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_POWER_MAX_EIRP.
480   * @NL80211_CMD_REQ_SET_REG: ask the wireless core to set the regulatory domain
481   *	to the specified ISO/IEC 3166-1 alpha2 country code. The core will
482   *	store this as a valid request and then query userspace for it.
483   *
484   * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG: Get mesh networking properties for the
485   *	interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX
486   *
487   * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG: Set mesh networking properties for the
488   *      interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX
489   *
490   * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE: Set extra IEs for management frames. The
491   *	interface is identified with %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and the management
492   *	frame subtype with %NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE. The extra IE data to be
493   *	added to the end of the specified management frame is specified with
494   *	%NL80211_ATTR_IE. If the command succeeds, the requested data will be
495   *	added to all specified management frames generated by
496   *	kernel/firmware/driver.
497   *	Note: This command has been removed and it is only reserved at this
498   *	point to avoid re-using existing command number. The functionality this
499   *	command was planned for has been provided with cleaner design with the
500   *	option to specify additional IEs in NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN,
501   *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE, NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE,
502   *	NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE, and NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE.
503   *
504   * @NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN: get scan results
505   * @NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN: trigger a new scan with the given parameters
506   *	%NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE is used to decide whether to send the
507   *	probe requests at CCK rate or not. %NL80211_ATTR_BSSID can be used to
508   *	specify a BSSID to scan for; if not included, the wildcard BSSID will
509   *	be used.
510   * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_SCAN_RESULTS: scan notification (as a reply to
511   *	NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN and on the "scan" multicast group)
512   * @NL80211_CMD_SCAN_ABORTED: scan was aborted, for unspecified reasons,
513   *	partial scan results may be available
514   *
515   * @NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN: start a scheduled scan at certain
516   *	intervals and certain number of cycles, as specified by
517   *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS. If %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS is
518   *	not specified and only %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL is specified,
519   *	scheduled scan will run in an infinite loop with the specified interval.
520   *	These attributes are mutually exclusive,
521   *	i.e. NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL must not be passed if
522   *	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS is defined.
523   *	If for some reason scheduled scan is aborted by the driver, all scan
524   *	plans are canceled (including scan plans that did not start yet).
525   *	Like with normal scans, if SSIDs (%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS)
526   *	are passed, they are used in the probe requests.  For
527   *	broadcast, a broadcast SSID must be passed (ie. an empty
528   *	string).  If no SSID is passed, no probe requests are sent and
529   *	a passive scan is performed.  %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES,
530   *	if passed, define which channels should be scanned; if not
531   *	passed, all channels allowed for the current regulatory domain
532   *	are used.  Extra IEs can also be passed from the userspace by
533   *	using the %NL80211_ATTR_IE attribute.  The first cycle of the
534   *	scheduled scan can be delayed by %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY
535   *	is supplied. If the device supports multiple concurrent scheduled
536   *	scans, it will allow such when the caller provides the flag attribute
537   *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI to indicate user-space support for it.
538   * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN: stop a scheduled scan. Returns -ENOENT if
539   *	scheduled scan is not running. The caller may assume that as soon
540   *	as the call returns, it is safe to start a new scheduled scan again.
541   * @NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_RESULTS: indicates that there are scheduled scan
542   *	results available.
543   * @NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_STOPPED: indicates that the scheduled scan has
544   *	stopped.  The driver may issue this event at any time during a
545   *	scheduled scan.  One reason for stopping the scan is if the hardware
546   *	does not support starting an association or a normal scan while running
547   *	a scheduled scan.  This event is also sent when the
548   *	%NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN command is received or when the interface
549   *	is brought down while a scheduled scan was running.
550   *
551   * @NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY: get survey results, e.g. channel occupation
552   *      or noise level
553   * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_SURVEY_RESULTS: survey data notification (as a reply to
554   *	NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY and on the "scan" multicast group)
555   *
556   * @NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA: Add a PMKSA cache entry using %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
557   *	(for the BSSID), %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID, and optionally %NL80211_ATTR_PMK
558   *	(PMK is used for PTKSA derivation in case of FILS shared key offload) or
559   *	using %NL80211_ATTR_SSID, %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID,
560   *	%NL80211_ATTR_PMKID, and %NL80211_ATTR_PMK in case of FILS
561   *	authentication where %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID is the identifier
562   *	advertised by a FILS capable AP identifying the scope of PMKSA in an
563   *	ESS.
564   * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA: Delete a PMKSA cache entry, using %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
565   *	(for the BSSID) and %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID or using %NL80211_ATTR_SSID,
566   *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID, and %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID in case of FILS
567   *	authentication. Additionally in case of SAE offload and OWE offloads
568   *	PMKSA entry can be deleted using %NL80211_ATTR_SSID.
569   * @NL80211_CMD_FLUSH_PMKSA: Flush all PMKSA cache entries.
570   *
571   * @NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE: indicates to userspace the regulatory domain
572   *	has been changed and provides details of the request information
573   *	that caused the change such as who initiated the regulatory request
574   *	(%NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR), the wiphy_idx
575   *	(%NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2) on which the request was made from if
576   *	the initiator was %NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE or
577   *	%NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER, the type of regulatory domain
578   *	set (%NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE), if the type of regulatory domain is
579   *	%NL80211_REG_TYPE_COUNTRY the alpha2 to which we have moved on
580   *	to (%NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2).
581   * @NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT: indicates to userspace that an AP beacon
582   *	has been found while world roaming thus enabling active scan or
583   *	any mode of operation that initiates TX (beacons) on a channel
584   *	where we would not have been able to do either before. As an example
585   *	if you are world roaming (regulatory domain set to world or if your
586   *	driver is using a custom world roaming regulatory domain) and while
587   *	doing a passive scan on the 5 GHz band you find an AP there (if not
588   *	on a DFS channel) you will now be able to actively scan for that AP
589   *	or use AP mode on your card on that same channel. Note that this will
590   *	never be used for channels 1-11 on the 2 GHz band as they are always
591   *	enabled world wide. This beacon hint is only sent if your device had
592   *	either disabled active scanning or beaconing on a channel. We send to
593   *	userspace the wiphy on which we removed a restriction from
594   *	(%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY) and the channel on which this occurred
595   *	before (%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE) and after (%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER)
596   *	the beacon hint was processed.
597   *
598   * @NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE: authentication request and notification.
599   *	This command is used both as a command (request to authenticate) and
600   *	as an event on the "mlme" multicast group indicating completion of the
601   *	authentication process.
602   *	When used as a command, %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to identify the
603   *	interface. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is used to specify PeerSTAAddress (and
604   *	BSSID in case of station mode). %NL80211_ATTR_SSID is used to specify
605   *	the SSID (mainly for association, but is included in authentication
606   *	request, too, to help BSS selection. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ +
607   *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET is used to specify the frequency of the
608   *	channel in MHz. %NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE is used to specify the
609   *	authentication type. %NL80211_ATTR_IE is used to define IEs
610   *	(VendorSpecificInfo, but also including RSN IE and FT IEs) to be added
611   *	to the frame.
612   *	When used as an event, this reports reception of an Authentication
613   *	frame in station and IBSS modes when the local MLME processed the
614   *	frame, i.e., it was for the local STA and was received in correct
615   *	state. This is similar to MLME-AUTHENTICATE.confirm primitive in the
616   *	MLME SAP interface (kernel providing MLME, userspace SME). The
617   *	included %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME attribute contains the management frame
618   *	(including both the header and frame body, but not FCS). This event is
619   *	also used to indicate if the authentication attempt timed out. In that
620   *	case the %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME attribute is replaced with a
621   *	%NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT flag (and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC to indicate which
622   *	pending authentication timed out).
623   * @NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE: association request and notification; like
624   *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Association and Reassociation
625   *	(similar to MLME-ASSOCIATE.request, MLME-REASSOCIATE.request,
626   *	MLME-ASSOCIATE.confirm or MLME-REASSOCIATE.confirm primitives). The
627   *	%NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID attribute is used to specify whether the
628   *	request is for the initial association to an ESS (that attribute not
629   *	included) or for reassociation within the ESS (that attribute is
630   *	included).
631   * @NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE: deauthentication request and notification; like
632   *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Deauthentication frames (similar to
633   *	MLME-DEAUTHENTICATION.request and MLME-DEAUTHENTICATE.indication
634   *	primitives).
635   * @NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE: disassociation request and notification; like
636   *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Disassociation frames (similar to
637   *	MLME-DISASSOCIATE.request and MLME-DISASSOCIATE.indication primitives).
638   *
639   * @NL80211_CMD_MICHAEL_MIC_FAILURE: notification of a locally detected Michael
640   *	MIC (part of TKIP) failure; sent on the "mlme" multicast group; the
641   *	event includes %NL80211_ATTR_MAC to describe the source MAC address of
642   *	the frame with invalid MIC, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE to show the key
643   *	type, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX to indicate the key identifier, and
644   *	%NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ to indicate the TSC value of the frame; this
645   *	event matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication() primitive
646   *
647   * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS: Join a new IBSS -- given at least an SSID and a
648   *	FREQ attribute (for the initial frequency if no peer can be found)
649   *	and optionally a MAC (as BSSID) and FREQ_FIXED attribute if those
650   *	should be fixed rather than automatically determined. Can only be
651   *	executed on a network interface that is UP, and fixed BSSID/FREQ
652   *	may be rejected. Another optional parameter is the beacon interval,
653   *	given in the %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL attribute, which if not
654   *	given defaults to 100 TU (102.4ms).
655   * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_IBSS: Leave the IBSS -- no special arguments, the IBSS is
656   *	determined by the network interface.
657   *
658   * @NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE: testmode command, takes a wiphy (or ifindex) attribute
659   *	to identify the device, and the TESTDATA blob attribute to pass through
660   *	to the driver.
661   *
662   * @NL80211_CMD_CONNECT: connection request and notification; this command
663   *	requests to connect to a specified network but without separating
664   *	auth and assoc steps. For this, you need to specify the SSID in a
665   *	%NL80211_ATTR_SSID attribute, and can optionally specify the association
666   *	IEs in %NL80211_ATTR_IE, %NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE,
667   *	%NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ,
668   *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET, %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT,
669   *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE,
670   *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT,
671   *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT, and
672   *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT.
673   *	If included, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ are
674   *	restrictions on BSS selection, i.e., they effectively prevent roaming
675   *	within the ESS. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT
676   *	can be included to provide a recommendation of the initial BSS while
677   *	allowing the driver to roam to other BSSes within the ESS and also to
678   *	ignore this recommendation if the indicated BSS is not ideal. Only one
679   *	set of BSSID,frequency parameters is used (i.e., either the enforcing
680   *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC,%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ or the less strict
681   *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT).
682   *	Driver shall not modify the IEs specified through %NL80211_ATTR_IE if
683   *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC is included. However, if %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT is
684   *	included, these IEs through %NL80211_ATTR_IE are specified by the user
685   *	space based on the best possible BSS selected. Thus, if the driver ends
686   *	up selecting a different BSS, it can modify these IEs accordingly (e.g.
687   *	userspace asks the driver to perform PMKSA caching with BSS1 and the
688   *	driver ends up selecting BSS2 with different PMKSA cache entry; RSNIE
689   *	has to get updated with the apt PMKID).
690   *	%NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID can be used to request a reassociation within
691   *	the ESS in case the device is already associated and an association with
692   *	a different BSS is desired.
693   *	Background scan period can optionally be
694   *	specified in %NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD,
695   *	if not specified default background scan configuration
696   *	in driver is used and if period value is 0, bg scan will be disabled.
697   *	This attribute is ignored if driver does not support roam scan.
698   *	It is also sent as an event, with the BSSID and response IEs when the
699   *	connection is established or failed to be established. This can be
700   *	determined by the %NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE attribute (0 = success,
701   *	non-zero = failure). If %NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT is included in the
702   *	event, the connection attempt failed due to not being able to initiate
703   *	authentication/association or not receiving a response from the AP.
704   *	Non-zero %NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE value is indicated in that case as
705   *	well to remain backwards compatible.
706   * @NL80211_CMD_ROAM: Notification indicating the card/driver roamed by itself.
707   *	When a security association was established on an 802.1X network using
708   *	fast transition, this event should be followed by an
709   *	%NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED event.
710   *	Following a %NL80211_CMD_ROAM event userspace can issue
711   *	%NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN in order to obtain the scan information for the
712   *	new BSS the card/driver roamed to.
713   * @NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT: drop a given connection; also used to notify
714   *	userspace that a connection was dropped by the AP or due to other
715   *	reasons, for this the %NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP and
716   *	%NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE attributes are used.
717   *
718   * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY_NETNS: Set a wiphy's netns. Note that all devices
719   *	associated with this wiphy must be down and will follow.
720   *
721   * @NL80211_CMD_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Request to remain awake on the specified
722   *	channel for the specified amount of time. This can be used to do
723   *	off-channel operations like transmit a Public Action frame and wait for
724   *	a response while being associated to an AP on another channel.
725   *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify which interface (and thus
726   *	radio) is used. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ is used to specify the
727   *	frequency for the operation.
728   *	%NL80211_ATTR_DURATION is used to specify the duration in milliseconds
729   *	to remain on the channel. This command is also used as an event to
730   *	notify when the requested duration starts (it may take a while for the
731   *	driver to schedule this time due to other concurrent needs for the
732   *	radio).
733   *	When called, this operation returns a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE)
734   *	that will be included with any events pertaining to this request;
735   *	the cookie is also used to cancel the request.
736   * @NL80211_CMD_CANCEL_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: This command can be used to cancel a
737   *	pending remain-on-channel duration if the desired operation has been
738   *	completed prior to expiration of the originally requested duration.
739   *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY or %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify the
740   *	radio. The %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE attribute must be given as well to
741   *	uniquely identify the request.
742   *	This command is also used as an event to notify when a requested
743   *	remain-on-channel duration has expired.
744   *
745   * @NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK: Set the mask of rates to be used in TX
746   *	rate selection. %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify the interface
747   *	and @NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES the set of allowed rates.
748   *
749   * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME: Register for receiving certain mgmt frames
750   *	(via @NL80211_CMD_FRAME) for processing in userspace. This command
751   *	requires an interface index, a frame type attribute (optional for
752   *	backward compatibility reasons, if not given assumes action frames)
753   *	and a match attribute containing the first few bytes of the frame
754   *	that should match, e.g. a single byte for only a category match or
755   *	four bytes for vendor frames including the OUI. The registration
756   *	cannot be dropped, but is removed automatically when the netlink
757   *	socket is closed. Multiple registrations can be made.
758   *	The %NL80211_ATTR_RECEIVE_MULTICAST flag attribute can be given if
759   *	%NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MULTICAST_REGISTRATIONS is available, in which
760   *	case the registration can also be modified to include/exclude the
761   *	flag, rather than requiring unregistration to change it.
762   * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_ACTION: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME for
763   *	backward compatibility
764   * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME: Management frame TX request and RX notification. This
765   *	command is used both as a request to transmit a management frame and
766   *	as an event indicating reception of a frame that was not processed in
767   *	kernel code, but is for us (i.e., which may need to be processed in a
768   *	user space application). %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the
769   *	frame contents (including header). %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ is used
770   *	to indicate on which channel the frame is to be transmitted or was
771   *	received. If this channel is not the current channel (remain-on-channel
772   *	or the operational channel) the device will switch to the given channel
773   *	and transmit the frame, optionally waiting for a response for the time
774   *	specified using %NL80211_ATTR_DURATION. When called, this operation
775   *	returns a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE) that will be included with the
776   *	TX status event pertaining to the TX request.
777   *	%NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE is used to decide whether to send the
778   *	management frames at CCK rate or not in 2GHz band.
779   *	%NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX is an array of offsets to CSA
780   *	counters which will be updated to the current value. This attribute
781   *	is used during CSA period.
782   *	For TX on an MLD, the frequency can be omitted and the link ID be
783   *	specified, or if transmitting to a known peer MLD (with MLD addresses
784   *	in the frame) both can be omitted and the link will be selected by
785   *	lower layers.
786   *	For RX notification, %NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP may be included to
787   *	indicate the frame RX timestamp and %NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP may
788   *	be included to indicate the ack TX timestamp.
789   * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_WAIT_CANCEL: When an off-channel TX was requested, this
790   *	command may be used with the corresponding cookie to cancel the wait
791   *	time if it is known that it is no longer necessary.  This command is
792   *	also sent as an event whenever the driver has completed the off-channel
793   *	wait time.
794   * @NL80211_CMD_ACTION: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_FRAME for backward compatibility.
795   * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS: Report TX status of a management frame
796   *	transmitted with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME. %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE identifies
797   *	the TX command and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME includes the contents of the
798   *	frame. %NL80211_ATTR_ACK flag is included if the recipient acknowledged
799   *	the frame. %NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP may be included to indicate the
800   *	tx timestamp and %NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP may be included to
801   *	indicate the ack RX timestamp.
802   * @NL80211_CMD_ACTION_TX_STATUS: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS for
803   *	backward compatibility.
804   *
805   * @NL80211_CMD_SET_POWER_SAVE: Set powersave, using %NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE
806   * @NL80211_CMD_GET_POWER_SAVE: Get powersave status in %NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE
807   *
808   * @NL80211_CMD_SET_CQM: Connection quality monitor configuration. This command
809   *	is used to configure connection quality monitoring notification trigger
810   *	levels.
811   * @NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM: Connection quality monitor notification. This
812   *	command is used as an event to indicate the that a trigger level was
813   *	reached.
814   * @NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL: Set the channel (using %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
815   *	and the attributes determining channel width) the given interface
816   *	(identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX) shall operate on.
817   *	In case multiple channels are supported by the device, the mechanism
818   *	with which it switches channels is implementation-defined.
819   *	When a monitor interface is given, it can only switch channel while
820   *	no other interfaces are operating to avoid disturbing the operation
821   *	of any other interfaces, and other interfaces will again take
822   *	precedence when they are used.
823   *
824   * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WDS_PEER: Set the MAC address of the peer on a WDS interface
825   *	(no longer supported).
826   *
827   * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST: Configure if this AP should perform
828   *	multicast to unicast conversion. When enabled, all multicast packets
829   *	with ethertype ARP, IPv4 or IPv6 (possibly within an 802.1Q header)
830   *	will be sent out to each station once with the destination (multicast)
831   *	MAC address replaced by the station's MAC address. Note that this may
832   *	break certain expectations of the receiver, e.g. the ability to drop
833   *	unicast IP packets encapsulated in multicast L2 frames, or the ability
834   *	to not send destination unreachable messages in such cases.
835   *	This can only be toggled per BSS. Configure this on an interface of
836   *	type %NL80211_IFTYPE_AP. It applies to all its VLAN interfaces
837   *	(%NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN), except for those in 4addr (WDS) mode.
838   *	If %NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED is not present with this
839   *	command, the feature is disabled.
840   *
841   * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH: Join a mesh. The mesh ID must be given, and initial
842   *	mesh config parameters may be given.
843   * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_MESH: Leave the mesh network -- no special arguments, the
844   *	network is determined by the network interface.
845   *
846   * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DEAUTHENTICATE: Unprotected deauthentication frame
847   *	notification. This event is used to indicate that an unprotected
848   *	deauthentication frame was dropped when MFP is in use.
849   * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DISASSOCIATE: Unprotected disassociation frame
850   *	notification. This event is used to indicate that an unprotected
851   *	disassociation frame was dropped when MFP is in use.
852   *
853   * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE: Notification on the reception of a
854   *      beacon or probe response from a compatible mesh peer.  This is only
855   *      sent while no station information (sta_info) exists for the new peer
856   *      candidate and when @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH,
857   *      @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE, or
858   *      @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM is set.  On reception of this
859   *      notification, userspace may decide to create a new station
860   *      (@NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION).  To stop this notification from
861   *      reoccurring, the userspace authentication daemon may want to create the
862   *      new station with the AUTHENTICATED flag unset and maybe change it later
863   *      depending on the authentication result.
864   *
865   * @NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN: get Wake-on-Wireless-LAN (WoWLAN) settings.
866   * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN: set Wake-on-Wireless-LAN (WoWLAN) settings.
867   *	Since wireless is more complex than wired ethernet, it supports
868   *	various triggers. These triggers can be configured through this
869   *	command with the %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS attribute. For
870   *	more background information, see
871   *	https://wireless.wiki.kernel.org/en/users/Documentation/WoWLAN.
872   *	The @NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN command can also be used as a notification
873   *	from the driver reporting the wakeup reason. In this case, the
874   *	@NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS attribute will contain the reason
875   *	for the wakeup, if it was caused by wireless. If it is not present
876   *	in the wakeup notification, the wireless device didn't cause the
877   *	wakeup but reports that it was woken up.
878   *
879   * @NL80211_CMD_SET_REKEY_OFFLOAD: This command is used give the driver
880   *	the necessary information for supporting GTK rekey offload. This
881   *	feature is typically used during WoWLAN. The configuration data
882   *	is contained in %NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA (which is nested and
883   *	contains the data in sub-attributes). After rekeying happened,
884   *	this command may also be sent by the driver as an MLME event to
885   *	inform userspace of the new replay counter.
886   *
887   * @NL80211_CMD_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: This is used as an event to inform userspace
888   *	of PMKSA caching candidates.
889   *
890   * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER: Perform a high-level TDLS command (e.g. link setup).
891   *	In addition, this can be used as an event to request userspace to take
892   *	actions on TDLS links (set up a new link or tear down an existing one).
893   *	In such events, %NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION indicates the requested
894   *	operation, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC contains the peer MAC address, and
895   *	%NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE the reason code to be used (only with
896   *	%NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN).
897   * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT: Send a TDLS management frame. The
898   *	%NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION attribute determines the type of frame to be
899   *	sent. Public Action codes (802.11-2012 8.1.5.1) will be sent as
900   *	802.11 management frames, while TDLS action codes (802.11-2012
901   *	8.5.13.1) will be encapsulated and sent as data frames. The currently
902   *	supported Public Action code is %WLAN_PUB_ACTION_TDLS_DISCOVER_RES
903   *	and the currently supported TDLS actions codes are given in
904   *	&enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode.
905   *
906   * @NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME: Used by an application controlling an AP
907   *	(or GO) interface (i.e. hostapd) to ask for unexpected frames to
908   *	implement sending deauth to stations that send unexpected class 3
909   *	frames. Also used as the event sent by the kernel when such a frame
910   *	is received.
911   *	For the event, the %NL80211_ATTR_MAC attribute carries the TA and
912   *	other attributes like the interface index are present.
913   *	If used as the command it must have an interface index and you can
914   *	only unsubscribe from the event by closing the socket. Subscription
915   *	is also for %NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME events.
916   *
917   * @NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME: Sent as an event indicating that the
918   *	associated station identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC sent a 4addr frame
919   *	and wasn't already in a 4-addr VLAN. The event will be sent similarly
920   *	to the %NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME event, to the same listener.
921   *
922   * @NL80211_CMD_PROBE_CLIENT: Probe an associated station on an AP interface
923   *	by sending a null data frame to it and reporting when the frame is
924   *	acknowledged. This is used to allow timing out inactive clients. Uses
925   *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. The command returns a
926   *	direct reply with an %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE that is later used to match
927   *	up the event with the request. The event includes the same data and
928   *	has %NL80211_ATTR_ACK set if the frame was ACKed.
929   *
930   * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_BEACONS: Register this socket to receive beacons from
931   *	other BSSes when any interfaces are in AP mode. This helps implement
932   *	OLBC handling in hostapd. Beacons are reported in %NL80211_CMD_FRAME
933   *	messages. Note that per PHY only one application may register.
934   *
935   * @NL80211_CMD_SET_NOACK_MAP: sets a bitmap for the individual TIDs whether
936   *      No Acknowledgement Policy should be applied.
937   *
938   * @NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_NOTIFY: An AP or GO may decide to switch channels
939   *	independently of the userspace SME, send this event indicating
940   *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is now on %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and the
941   *	attributes determining channel width.  This indication may also be
942   *	sent when a remotely-initiated switch (e.g., when a STA receives a CSA
943   *	from the remote AP) is completed;
944   *
945   * @NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_STARTED_NOTIFY: Notify that a channel switch
946   *	has been started on an interface, regardless of the initiator
947   *	(ie. whether it was requested from a remote device or
948   *	initiated on our own).  It indicates that
949   *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX will be on %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
950   *	after %NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT TBTT's.  The userspace may
951   *	decide to react to this indication by requesting other
952   *	interfaces to change channel as well.
953   *
954   * @NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE: Start the given P2P Device, identified by
955   *	its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV identifier. It must have been created with
956   *	%NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE previously. After it has been started, the
957   *	P2P Device can be used for P2P operations, e.g. remain-on-channel and
958   *	public action frame TX.
959   * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE: Stop the given P2P Device, identified by
960   *	its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV identifier.
961   *
962   * @NL80211_CMD_CONN_FAILED: connection request to an AP failed; used to
963   *	notify userspace that AP has rejected the connection request from a
964   *	station, due to particular reason. %NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON
965   *	is used for this.
966   *
967   * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MCAST_RATE: Change the rate used to send multicast frames
968   *	for IBSS or MESH vif.
969   *
970   * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL: sets ACL for MAC address based access control.
971   *	This is to be used with the drivers advertising the support of MAC
972   *	address based access control. List of MAC addresses is passed in
973   *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS and ACL policy is passed in
974   *	%NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY. Driver will enable ACL with this list, if it
975   *	is not already done. The new list will replace any existing list. Driver
976   *	will clear its ACL when the list of MAC addresses passed is empty. This
977   *	command is used in AP/P2P GO mode. Driver has to make sure to clear its
978   *	ACL list during %NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP.
979   *
980   * @NL80211_CMD_RADAR_DETECT: Start a Channel availability check (CAC). Once
981   *	a radar is detected or the channel availability scan (CAC) has finished
982   *	or was aborted, or a radar was detected, usermode will be notified with
983   *	this event. This command is also used to notify userspace about radars
984   *	while operating on this channel.
985   *	%NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT is used to inform about the type of the
986   *	event.
987   *
988   * @NL80211_CMD_GET_PROTOCOL_FEATURES: Get global nl80211 protocol features,
989   *	i.e. features for the nl80211 protocol rather than device features.
990   *	Returns the features in the %NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES bitmap.
991   *
992   * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_FT_IES: Pass down the most up-to-date Fast Transition
993   *	Information Element to the WLAN driver
994   *
995   * @NL80211_CMD_FT_EVENT: Send a Fast transition event from the WLAN driver
996   *	to the supplicant. This will carry the target AP's MAC address along
997   *	with the relevant Information Elements. This event is used to report
998   *	received FT IEs (MDIE, FTIE, RSN IE, TIE, RICIE).
999   *
1000   * @NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_START: Indicates user-space will start running
1001   *	a critical protocol that needs more reliability in the connection to
1002   *	complete.
1003   *
1004   * @NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_STOP: Indicates the connection reliability can
1005   *	return back to normal.
1006   *
1007   * @NL80211_CMD_GET_COALESCE: Get currently supported coalesce rules.
1008   * @NL80211_CMD_SET_COALESCE: Configure coalesce rules or clear existing rules.
1009   *
1010   * @NL80211_CMD_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Perform a channel switch by announcing the
1011   *	new channel information (Channel Switch Announcement - CSA)
1012   *	in the beacon for some time (as defined in the
1013   *	%NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT parameter) and then change to the
1014   *	new channel. Userspace provides the new channel information (using
1015   *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and the attributes determining channel
1016   *	width). %NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX may be supplied to inform
1017   *	other station that transmission must be blocked until the channel
1018   *	switch is complete.
1019   *
1020   * @NL80211_CMD_VENDOR: Vendor-specified command/event. The command is specified
1021   *	by the %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID attribute and a sub-command in
1022   *	%NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD. Parameter(s) can be transported in
1023   *	%NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA.
1024   *	For feature advertisement, the %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute is
1025   *	used in the wiphy data as a nested attribute containing descriptions
1026   *	(&struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info) of the supported vendor commands.
1027   *	This may also be sent as an event with the same attributes.
1028   *
1029   * @NL80211_CMD_SET_QOS_MAP: Set Interworking QoS mapping for IP DSCP values.
1030   *	The QoS mapping information is included in %NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP. If
1031   *	that attribute is not included, QoS mapping is disabled. Since this
1032   *	QoS mapping is relevant for IP packets, it is only valid during an
1033   *	association. This is cleared on disassociation and AP restart.
1034   *
1035   * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS: Ask the kernel to add a traffic stream for the given
1036   *	%NL80211_ATTR_TSID and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC with %NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO
1037   *	and %NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME parameters.
1038   *	Note that the action frame handshake with the AP shall be handled by
1039   *	userspace via the normal management RX/TX framework, this only sets
1040   *	up the TX TS in the driver/device.
1041   *	If the admitted time attribute is not added then the request just checks
1042   *	if a subsequent setup could be successful, the intent is to use this to
1043   *	avoid setting up a session with the AP when local restrictions would
1044   *	make that impossible. However, the subsequent "real" setup may still
1045   *	fail even if the check was successful.
1046   * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_TX_TS: Remove an existing TS with the %NL80211_ATTR_TSID
1047   *	and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC parameters. It isn't necessary to call this
1048   *	before removing a station entry entirely, or before disassociating
1049   *	or similar, cleanup will happen in the driver/device in this case.
1050   *
1051   * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MPP: Get mesh path attributes for mesh proxy path to
1052   *	destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by
1053   *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
1054   *
1055   * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_OCB: Join the OCB network. The center frequency and
1056   *	bandwidth of a channel must be given.
1057   * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_OCB: Leave the OCB network -- no special arguments, the
1058   *	network is determined by the network interface.
1059   *
1060   * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer,
1061   *	identified by the %NL80211_ATTR_MAC parameter. A target channel is
1062   *	provided via %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and other attributes determining
1063   *	channel width/type. The target operating class is given via
1064   *	%NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS.
1065   *	The driver is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching
1066   *	operations and returning to the base channel for communication with the
1067   *	AP.
1068   * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CANCEL_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS
1069   *	peer given by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. Both peers must be on the base channel
1070   *	when this command completes.
1071   *
1072   * @NL80211_CMD_WIPHY_REG_CHANGE: Similar to %NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE, but used
1073   *	as an event to indicate changes for devices with wiphy-specific regdom
1074   *	management.
1075   *
1076   * @NL80211_CMD_ABORT_SCAN: Stop an ongoing scan. Returns -ENOENT if a scan is
1077   *	not running. The driver indicates the status of the scan through
1078   *	cfg80211_scan_done().
1079   *
1080   * @NL80211_CMD_START_NAN: Start NAN operation, identified by its
1081   *	%NL80211_ATTR_WDEV interface. This interface must have been
1082   *	previously created with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE. After it
1083   *	has been started, the NAN interface will create or join a
1084   *	cluster. This command must have a valid
1085   *	%NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF attribute and optional
1086   *	%NL80211_ATTR_BANDS attributes.  If %NL80211_ATTR_BANDS is
1087   *	omitted or set to 0, it means don't-care and the device will
1088   *	decide what to use.  After this command NAN functions can be
1089   *	added.
1090   * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_NAN: Stop the NAN operation, identified by
1091   *	its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV interface.
1092   * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_NAN_FUNCTION: Add a NAN function. The function is defined
1093   *	with %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC nested attribute. When called, this
1094   *	operation returns the strictly positive and unique instance id
1095   *	(%NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC_INST_ID) and a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE)
1096   *	of the function upon success.
1097   *	Since instance ID's can be re-used, this cookie is the right
1098   *	way to identify the function. This will avoid races when a termination
1099   *	event is handled by the user space after it has already added a new
1100   *	function that got the same instance id from the kernel as the one
1101   *	which just terminated.
1102   *	This cookie may be used in NAN events even before the command
1103   *	returns, so userspace shouldn't process NAN events until it processes
1104   *	the response to this command.
1105   *	Look at %NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER as well.
1106   * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_NAN_FUNCTION: Delete a NAN function by cookie.
1107   *	This command is also used as a notification sent when a NAN function is
1108   *	terminated. This will contain a %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC_INST_ID
1109   *	and %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE attributes.
1110   * @NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG: Change current NAN
1111   *	configuration. NAN must be operational (%NL80211_CMD_START_NAN
1112   *	was executed).  It must contain at least one of the following
1113   *	attributes: %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF,
1114   *	%NL80211_ATTR_BANDS.  If %NL80211_ATTR_BANDS is omitted, the
1115   *	current configuration is not changed.  If it is present but
1116   *	set to zero, the configuration is changed to don't-care
1117   *	(i.e. the device can decide what to do).
1118   * @NL80211_CMD_NAN_MATCH: Notification sent when a match is reported.
1119   *	This will contain a %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH nested attribute and
1120   *	%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE.
1121   *
1122   * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS: Update one or more connect parameters
1123   *	for subsequent roaming cases if the driver or firmware uses internal
1124   *	BSS selection. This command can be issued only while connected and it
1125   *	does not result in a change for the current association. Currently,
1126   *	only the %NL80211_ATTR_IE data is used and updated with this command.
1127   *
1128   * @NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK: For offloaded 4-Way handshake, set the PMK or PMK-R0
1129   *	for the given authenticator address (specified with %NL80211_ATTR_MAC).
1130   *	When %NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME is set, %NL80211_ATTR_PMK specifies the
1131   *	PMK-R0, otherwise it specifies the PMK.
1132   * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMK: For offloaded 4-Way handshake, delete the previously
1133   *	configured PMK for the authenticator address identified by
1134   *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC.
1135   * @NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED: An event that indicates port is authorized and
1136   *	open for regular data traffic. For STA/P2P-client, this event is sent
1137   *	with AP MAC address and for AP/P2P-GO, the event carries the STA/P2P-
1138   *	client MAC address.
1139   *	Drivers that support 4 way handshake offload should send this event for
1140   *	STA/P2P-client after successful 4-way HS or after 802.1X FT following
1141   *	NL80211_CMD_CONNECT or NL80211_CMD_ROAM. Drivers using AP/P2P-GO 4-way
1142   *	handshake offload should send this event on successful completion of
1143   *	4-way handshake with the peer (STA/P2P-client).
1144   * @NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME: Control Port (e.g. PAE) frame TX request
1145   *	and RX notification.  This command is used both as a request to transmit
1146   *	a control port frame and as a notification that a control port frame
1147   *	has been received. %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the
1148   *	frame contents.  The frame is the raw EAPoL data, without ethernet or
1149   *	802.11 headers.
1150   *	For an MLD transmitter, the %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID may be given and
1151   *	its effect will depend on the destination: If the destination is known
1152   *	to be an MLD, this will be used as a hint to select the link to transmit
1153   *	the frame on. If the destination is not an MLD, this will select both
1154   *	the link to transmit on and the source address will be set to the link
1155   *	address of that link.
1156   *	When used as an event indication %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE,
1157   *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC are added
1158   *	indicating the protocol type of the received frame; whether the frame
1159   *	was received unencrypted and the MAC address of the peer respectively.
1160   *
1161   * @NL80211_CMD_RELOAD_REGDB: Request that the regdb firmware file is reloaded.
1162   *
1163   * @NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH: This interface is exclusively defined for host
1164   *	drivers that do not define separate commands for authentication and
1165   *	association, but rely on user space for the authentication to happen.
1166   *	This interface acts both as the event request (driver to user space)
1167   *	to trigger the authentication and command response (userspace to
1168   *	driver) to indicate the authentication status.
1169   *
1170   *	User space uses the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT command to the host driver to
1171   *	trigger a connection. The host driver selects a BSS and further uses
1172   *	this interface to offload only the authentication part to the user
1173   *	space. Authentication frames are passed between the driver and user
1174   *	space through the %NL80211_CMD_FRAME interface. Host driver proceeds
1175   *	further with the association after getting successful authentication
1176   *	status. User space indicates the authentication status through
1177   *	%NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE attribute in %NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH
1178   *	command interface.
1179   *
1180   *	Host driver sends MLD address of the AP with %NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR in
1181   *	%NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH event to indicate user space to enable MLO
1182   *	during the authentication offload in STA mode while connecting to MLD
1183   *	APs. Host driver should check %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT flag capability
1184   *	in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to know whether the user space supports enabling
1185   *	MLO during the authentication offload or not.
1186   *	User space should enable MLO during the authentication only when it
1187   *	receives the AP MLD address in authentication offload request. User
1188   *	space shouldn't enable MLO when the authentication offload request
1189   *	doesn't indicate the AP MLD address even if the AP is MLO capable.
1190   *	User space should use %NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR as peer's MLD address and
1191   *	interface address identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX as self MLD
1192   *	address. User space and host driver to use MLD addresses in RA, TA and
1193   *	BSSID fields of the frames between them, and host driver translates the
1194   *	MLD addresses to/from link addresses based on the link chosen for the
1195   *	authentication.
1196   *
1197   *	Host driver reports this status on an authentication failure to the
1198   *	user space through the connect result as the user space would have
1199   *	initiated the connection through the connect request.
1200   *
1201   * @NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED: An event that notify station's
1202   *	ht opmode or vht opmode changes using any of %NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE,
1203   *	%NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH,%NL80211_ATTR_NSS attributes with its
1204   *	address(specified in %NL80211_ATTR_MAC).
1205   *
1206   * @NL80211_CMD_GET_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, in
1207   *	the %NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS attribute.
1208   *
1209   * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_START: start a (set of) peer measurement(s)
1210   *	with the given parameters, which are encapsulated in the nested
1211   *	%NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS attribute. Optionally, MAC address
1212   *	randomization may be enabled and configured by specifying the
1213   *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK attributes.
1214   *	If a timeout is requested, use the %NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT attribute.
1215   *	A u64 cookie for further %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE use is returned in
1216   *	the netlink extended ack message.
1217   *
1218   *	To cancel a measurement, close the socket that requested it.
1219   *
1220   *	Measurement results are reported to the socket that requested the
1221   *	measurement using @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT when they
1222   *	become available, so applications must ensure a large enough socket
1223   *	buffer size.
1224   *
1225   *	Depending on driver support it may or may not be possible to start
1226   *	multiple concurrent measurements.
1227   * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT: This command number is used for the
1228   *	result notification from the driver to the requesting socket.
1229   * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_COMPLETE: Notification only, indicating that
1230   *	the measurement completed, using the measurement cookie
1231   *	(%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE).
1232   *
1233   * @NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_RADAR: Notify the kernel that a radar signal was
1234   *	detected and reported by a neighboring device on the channel
1235   *	indicated by %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and other attributes
1236   *	determining the width and type.
1237   *
1238   * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_OWE_INFO: This interface allows the host driver to
1239   *	offload OWE processing to user space. This intends to support
1240   *	OWE AKM by the host drivers that implement SME but rely
1241   *	on the user space for the cryptographic/DH IE processing in AP mode.
1242   *
1243   * @NL80211_CMD_PROBE_MESH_LINK: The requirement for mesh link metric
1244   *	refreshing, is that from one mesh point we be able to send some data
1245   *	frames to other mesh points which are not currently selected as a
1246   *	primary traffic path, but which are only 1 hop away. The absence of
1247   *	the primary path to the chosen node makes it necessary to apply some
1248   *	form of marking on a chosen packet stream so that the packets can be
1249   *	properly steered to the selected node for testing, and not by the
1250   *	regular mesh path lookup. Further, the packets must be of type data
1251   *	so that the rate control (often embedded in firmware) is used for
1252   *	rate selection.
1253   *
1254   *	Here attribute %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is used to specify connected mesh
1255   *	peer MAC address and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the frame
1256   *	content. The frame is ethernet data.
1257   *
1258   * @NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG: Data frame TID specific configuration
1259   *	is passed using %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG attribute.
1260   *
1261   * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_BEACON: Unprotected or incorrectly protected Beacon
1262   *	frame. This event is used to indicate that a received Beacon frame was
1263   *	dropped because it did not include a valid MME MIC while beacon
1264   *	protection was enabled (BIGTK configured in station mode).
1265   *
1266   * @NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME_TX_STATUS: Report TX status of a control
1267   *	port frame transmitted with %NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME.
1268   *	%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE identifies the TX command and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME
1269   *	includes the contents of the frame. %NL80211_ATTR_ACK flag is included
1270   *	if the recipient acknowledged the frame.
1271   *
1272   * @NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPECS: SAR power limitation configuration is
1273   *	passed using %NL80211_ATTR_SAR_SPEC. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY is used to
1274   *	specify the wiphy index to be applied to.
1275   *
1276   * @NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION: This notification is sent out whenever
1277   *	mac80211/drv detects a bss color collision.
1278   *
1279   * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_REQUEST: This command is used to indicate that
1280   *	userspace wants to change the BSS color.
1281   *
1282   * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_STARTED: Notify userland, that a color change has
1283   *	started
1284   *
1285   * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_ABORTED: Notify userland, that the color change has
1286   *	been aborted
1287   *
1288   * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_COMPLETED: Notify userland that the color change
1289   *	has completed
1290   *
1291   * @NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD: Set FILS AAD data to the driver using -
1292   *	&NL80211_ATTR_MAC - for STA MAC address
1293   *	&NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK - for KEK
1294   *	&NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES - for FILS Nonces
1295   *		(STA Nonce 16 bytes followed by AP Nonce 16 bytes)
1296   *
1297   * @NL80211_CMD_ASSOC_COMEBACK: notification about an association
1298   *      temporal rejection with comeback. The event includes %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
1299   *      to describe the BSSID address of the AP and %NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT to
1300   *      specify the timeout value.
1301   *
1302   * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK: Add a new link to an interface. The
1303   *	%NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID attribute is used for the new link.
1304   * @NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK: Remove a link from an interface. This may come
1305   *	without %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID as an easy way to remove all links
1306   *	in preparation for e.g. roaming to a regular (non-MLO) AP.
1307   *
1308   * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK_STA: Add a link to an MLD station
1309   * @NL80211_CMD_MODIFY_LINK_STA: Modify a link of an MLD station
1310   * @NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK_STA: Remove a link of an MLD station
1311   *
1312   * @NL80211_CMD_SET_HW_TIMESTAMP: Enable/disable HW timestamping of Timing
1313   *	measurement and Fine timing measurement frames. If %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
1314   *	is included, enable/disable HW timestamping only for frames to/from the
1315   *	specified MAC address. Otherwise enable/disable HW timestamping for
1316   *	all TM/FTM frames (including ones that were enabled with specific MAC
1317   *	address). If %NL80211_ATTR_HW_TIMESTAMP_ENABLED is not included, disable
1318   *	HW timestamping.
1319   *	The number of peers that HW timestamping can be enabled for concurrently
1320   *	is indicated by %NL80211_ATTR_MAX_HW_TIMESTAMP_PEERS.
1321   *
1322   * @NL80211_CMD_LINKS_REMOVED: Notify userspace about the removal of STA MLD
1323   *	setup links due to AP MLD removing the corresponding affiliated APs with
1324   *	Multi-Link reconfiguration. %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS is used to provide
1325   *	information about the removed STA MLD setup links.
1326   *
1327   * @NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_TO_LINK_MAPPING: Set the TID to Link Mapping for a
1328   *      non-AP MLD station. The %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_TTLM_DLINK and
1329   *      %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_TTLM_ULINK attributes are used to specify the
1330   *      TID to Link mapping for downlink/uplink traffic.
1331   *
1332   * @NL80211_CMD_MAX: highest used command number
1333   * @__NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST: internal use
1334   */
1335  enum nl80211_commands {
1336  /* don't change the order or add anything between, this is ABI! */
1337  	NL80211_CMD_UNSPEC,
1338  
1339  	NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY,		/* can dump */
1340  	NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY,
1341  	NL80211_CMD_NEW_WIPHY,
1342  	NL80211_CMD_DEL_WIPHY,
1343  
1344  	NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE,	/* can dump */
1345  	NL80211_CMD_SET_INTERFACE,
1346  	NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE,
1347  	NL80211_CMD_DEL_INTERFACE,
1348  
1349  	NL80211_CMD_GET_KEY,
1350  	NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY,
1351  	NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY,
1352  	NL80211_CMD_DEL_KEY,
1353  
1354  	NL80211_CMD_GET_BEACON,
1355  	NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON,
1356  	NL80211_CMD_START_AP,
1357  	NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON = NL80211_CMD_START_AP,
1358  	NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP,
1359  	NL80211_CMD_DEL_BEACON = NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP,
1360  
1361  	NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION,
1362  	NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION,
1363  	NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION,
1364  	NL80211_CMD_DEL_STATION,
1365  
1366  	NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH,
1367  	NL80211_CMD_SET_MPATH,
1368  	NL80211_CMD_NEW_MPATH,
1369  	NL80211_CMD_DEL_MPATH,
1370  
1371  	NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS,
1372  
1373  	NL80211_CMD_SET_REG,
1374  	NL80211_CMD_REQ_SET_REG,
1375  
1376  	NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG,
1377  	NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG,
1378  
1379  	NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE /* reserved; not used */,
1380  
1381  	NL80211_CMD_GET_REG,
1382  
1383  	NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN,
1384  	NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN,
1385  	NL80211_CMD_NEW_SCAN_RESULTS,
1386  	NL80211_CMD_SCAN_ABORTED,
1387  
1388  	NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE,
1389  
1390  	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE,
1391  	NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE,
1392  	NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE,
1393  	NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE,
1394  
1395  	NL80211_CMD_MICHAEL_MIC_FAILURE,
1396  
1397  	NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT,
1398  
1399  	NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS,
1400  	NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_IBSS,
1401  
1402  	NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
1403  
1404  	NL80211_CMD_CONNECT,
1405  	NL80211_CMD_ROAM,
1406  	NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT,
1407  
1408  	NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY_NETNS,
1409  
1410  	NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY,
1411  	NL80211_CMD_NEW_SURVEY_RESULTS,
1412  
1413  	NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA,
1414  	NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA,
1415  	NL80211_CMD_FLUSH_PMKSA,
1416  
1417  	NL80211_CMD_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL,
1418  	NL80211_CMD_CANCEL_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL,
1419  
1420  	NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK,
1421  
1422  	NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME,
1423  	NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_ACTION = NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME,
1424  	NL80211_CMD_FRAME,
1425  	NL80211_CMD_ACTION = NL80211_CMD_FRAME,
1426  	NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS,
1427  	NL80211_CMD_ACTION_TX_STATUS = NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS,
1428  
1429  	NL80211_CMD_SET_POWER_SAVE,
1430  	NL80211_CMD_GET_POWER_SAVE,
1431  
1432  	NL80211_CMD_SET_CQM,
1433  	NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM,
1434  
1435  	NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL,
1436  	NL80211_CMD_SET_WDS_PEER,
1437  
1438  	NL80211_CMD_FRAME_WAIT_CANCEL,
1439  
1440  	NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH,
1441  	NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_MESH,
1442  
1443  	NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DEAUTHENTICATE,
1444  	NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DISASSOCIATE,
1445  
1446  	NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE,
1447  
1448  	NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN,
1449  	NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN,
1450  
1451  	NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN,
1452  	NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN,
1453  	NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_RESULTS,
1454  	NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_STOPPED,
1455  
1456  	NL80211_CMD_SET_REKEY_OFFLOAD,
1457  
1458  	NL80211_CMD_PMKSA_CANDIDATE,
1459  
1460  	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER,
1461  	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT,
1462  
1463  	NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME,
1464  
1465  	NL80211_CMD_PROBE_CLIENT,
1466  
1467  	NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_BEACONS,
1468  
1469  	NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME,
1470  
1471  	NL80211_CMD_SET_NOACK_MAP,
1472  
1473  	NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_NOTIFY,
1474  
1475  	NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE,
1476  	NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE,
1477  
1478  	NL80211_CMD_CONN_FAILED,
1479  
1480  	NL80211_CMD_SET_MCAST_RATE,
1481  
1482  	NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL,
1483  
1484  	NL80211_CMD_RADAR_DETECT,
1485  
1486  	NL80211_CMD_GET_PROTOCOL_FEATURES,
1487  
1488  	NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_FT_IES,
1489  	NL80211_CMD_FT_EVENT,
1490  
1491  	NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_START,
1492  	NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_STOP,
1493  
1494  	NL80211_CMD_GET_COALESCE,
1495  	NL80211_CMD_SET_COALESCE,
1496  
1497  	NL80211_CMD_CHANNEL_SWITCH,
1498  
1499  	NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
1500  
1501  	NL80211_CMD_SET_QOS_MAP,
1502  
1503  	NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS,
1504  	NL80211_CMD_DEL_TX_TS,
1505  
1506  	NL80211_CMD_GET_MPP,
1507  
1508  	NL80211_CMD_JOIN_OCB,
1509  	NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_OCB,
1510  
1511  	NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_STARTED_NOTIFY,
1512  
1513  	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH,
1514  	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CANCEL_CHANNEL_SWITCH,
1515  
1516  	NL80211_CMD_WIPHY_REG_CHANGE,
1517  
1518  	NL80211_CMD_ABORT_SCAN,
1519  
1520  	NL80211_CMD_START_NAN,
1521  	NL80211_CMD_STOP_NAN,
1522  	NL80211_CMD_ADD_NAN_FUNCTION,
1523  	NL80211_CMD_DEL_NAN_FUNCTION,
1524  	NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG,
1525  	NL80211_CMD_NAN_MATCH,
1526  
1527  	NL80211_CMD_SET_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST,
1528  
1529  	NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS,
1530  
1531  	NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK,
1532  	NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMK,
1533  
1534  	NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED,
1535  
1536  	NL80211_CMD_RELOAD_REGDB,
1537  
1538  	NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH,
1539  
1540  	NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED,
1541  
1542  	NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME,
1543  
1544  	NL80211_CMD_GET_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS,
1545  
1546  	NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_START,
1547  	NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT,
1548  	NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_COMPLETE,
1549  
1550  	NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_RADAR,
1551  
1552  	NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_OWE_INFO,
1553  
1554  	NL80211_CMD_PROBE_MESH_LINK,
1555  
1556  	NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG,
1557  
1558  	NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_BEACON,
1559  
1560  	NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME_TX_STATUS,
1561  
1562  	NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPECS,
1563  
1564  	NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION,
1565  
1566  	NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_REQUEST,
1567  
1568  	NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_STARTED,
1569  	NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_ABORTED,
1570  	NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_COMPLETED,
1571  
1572  	NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD,
1573  
1574  	NL80211_CMD_ASSOC_COMEBACK,
1575  
1576  	NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK,
1577  	NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK,
1578  
1579  	NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK_STA,
1580  	NL80211_CMD_MODIFY_LINK_STA,
1581  	NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK_STA,
1582  
1583  	NL80211_CMD_SET_HW_TIMESTAMP,
1584  
1585  	NL80211_CMD_LINKS_REMOVED,
1586  
1587  	NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_TO_LINK_MAPPING,
1588  
1589  	/* add new commands above here */
1590  
1591  	/* used to define NL80211_CMD_MAX below */
1592  	__NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST,
1593  	NL80211_CMD_MAX = __NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST - 1
1594  };
1595  
1596  /*
1597   * Allow user space programs to use #ifdef on new commands by defining them
1598   * here
1599   */
1600  #define NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS
1601  #define NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE
1602  #define NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE
1603  #define NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE
1604  #define NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE
1605  #define NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE
1606  #define NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE
1607  #define NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT
1608  
1609  #define NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS
1610  
1611  /* source-level API compatibility */
1612  #define NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG
1613  #define NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG
1614  #define NL80211_MESH_SETUP_VENDOR_PATH_SEL_IE NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE
1615  
1616  /**
1617   * enum nl80211_attrs - nl80211 netlink attributes
1618   *
1619   * @NL80211_ATTR_UNSPEC: unspecified attribute to catch errors
1620   *
1621   * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY: index of wiphy to operate on, cf.
1622   *	/sys/class/ieee80211/<phyname>/index
1623   * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME: wiphy name (used for renaming)
1624   * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS: a nested array of TX queue parameters
1625   * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ: frequency of the selected channel in MHz,
1626   *	defines the channel together with the (deprecated)
1627   *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE attribute or the attributes
1628   *	%NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH and if needed %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
1629   *	and %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2
1630   * @NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH: u32 attribute containing one of the values
1631   *	of &enum nl80211_chan_width, describing the channel width. See the
1632   *	documentation of the enum for more information.
1633   * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1: Center frequency of the first part of the
1634   *	channel, used for anything but 20 MHz bandwidth. In S1G this is the
1635   *	operating channel center frequency.
1636   * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2: Center frequency of the second part of the
1637   *	channel, used only for 80+80 MHz bandwidth
1638   * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE: included with NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
1639   *	if HT20 or HT40 are to be used (i.e., HT disabled if not included):
1640   *	NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT = HT not allowed (i.e., same as not including
1641   *		this attribute)
1642   *	NL80211_CHAN_HT20 = HT20 only
1643   *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS = secondary channel is below the primary channel
1644   *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS = secondary channel is above the primary channel
1645   *	This attribute is now deprecated.
1646   * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT: TX retry limit for frames whose length is
1647   *	less than or equal to the RTS threshold; allowed range: 1..255;
1648   *	dot11ShortRetryLimit; u8
1649   * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG: TX retry limit for frames whose length is
1650   *	greater than the RTS threshold; allowed range: 1..255;
1651   *	dot11ShortLongLimit; u8
1652   * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD: fragmentation threshold, i.e., maximum
1653   *	length in octets for frames; allowed range: 256..8000, disable
1654   *	fragmentation with (u32)-1; dot11FragmentationThreshold; u32
1655   * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD: RTS threshold (TX frames with length
1656   *	larger than or equal to this use RTS/CTS handshake); allowed range:
1657   *	0..65536, disable with (u32)-1; dot11RTSThreshold; u32
1658   * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_COVERAGE_CLASS: Coverage Class as defined by IEEE 802.11
1659   *	section 7.3.2.9; dot11CoverageClass; u8
1660   *
1661   * @NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX: network interface index of the device to operate on
1662   * @NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME: network interface name
1663   * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE: type of virtual interface, see &enum nl80211_iftype
1664   *
1665   * @NL80211_ATTR_WDEV: wireless device identifier, used for pseudo-devices
1666   *	that don't have a netdev (u64)
1667   *
1668   * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC: MAC address (various uses)
1669   *
1670   * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA: (temporal) key data; for TKIP this consists of
1671   *	16 bytes encryption key followed by 8 bytes each for TX and RX MIC
1672   *	keys
1673   * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX: key ID (u8, 0-3)
1674   * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER: key cipher suite (u32, as defined by IEEE 802.11
1675   *	section 7.3.2.25.1, e.g. 0x000FAC04)
1676   * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ: transmit key sequence number (IV/PN) for TKIP and
1677   *	CCMP keys, each six bytes in little endian
1678   * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT: Flag attribute indicating the key is default key
1679   * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT: Flag attribute indicating the key is the
1680   *	default management key
1681   * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE: For crypto settings for connect or
1682   *	other commands, indicates which pairwise cipher suites are used
1683   * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP: For crypto settings for connect or
1684   *	other commands, indicates which group cipher suite is used
1685   *
1686   * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL: beacon interval in TU
1687   * @NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD: DTIM period for beaconing
1688   * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD: portion of the beacon before the TIM IE
1689   * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL: portion of the beacon after the TIM IE
1690   *
1691   * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID: Association ID for the station (u16)
1692   * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS: flags, nested element with NLA_FLAG attributes of
1693   *	&enum nl80211_sta_flags (deprecated, use %NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2)
1694   * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_LISTEN_INTERVAL: listen interval as defined by
1695   *	IEEE 802.11 7.3.1.6 (u16).
1696   * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_RATES: supported rates, array of supported
1697   *	rates as defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but without the length
1698   *	restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES).
1699   * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN: interface index of VLAN interface to move station
1700   *	to, or the AP interface the station was originally added to.
1701   * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO: information about a station, part of station info
1702   *	given for %NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION, nested attribute containing
1703   *	info as possible, see &enum nl80211_sta_info.
1704   *
1705   * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_BANDS: Information about an operating bands,
1706   *	consisting of a nested array.
1707   *
1708   * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_ID: mesh id (1-32 bytes).
1709   * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_ACTION: action to perform on the mesh peer link
1710   *	(see &enum nl80211_plink_action).
1711   * @NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP: MAC address of the next hop for a mesh path.
1712   * @NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO: information about a mesh_path, part of mesh path
1713   *	info given for %NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH, nested attribute described at
1714   *	&enum nl80211_mpath_info.
1715   *
1716   * @NL80211_ATTR_MNTR_FLAGS: flags, nested element with NLA_FLAG attributes of
1717   *      &enum nl80211_mntr_flags.
1718   *
1719   * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2: an ISO-3166-alpha2 country code for which the
1720   *	current regulatory domain should be set to or is already set to.
1721   *	For example, 'CR', for Costa Rica. This attribute is used by the kernel
1722   *	to query the CRDA to retrieve one regulatory domain. This attribute can
1723   *	also be used by userspace to query the kernel for the currently set
1724   *	regulatory domain. We chose an alpha2 as that is also used by the
1725   *	IEEE-802.11 country information element to identify a country.
1726   *	Users can also simply ask the wireless core to set regulatory domain
1727   *	to a specific alpha2.
1728   * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULES: a nested array of regulatory domain regulatory
1729   *	rules.
1730   *
1731   * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled (u8, 0 or 1)
1732   * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled
1733   *	(u8, 0 or 1)
1734   * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time enabled
1735   *	(u8, 0 or 1)
1736   * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES: basic rates, array of basic
1737   *	rates in format defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but without the length
1738   *	restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES).
1739   *
1740   * @NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY: HT Capability information element (from
1741   *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION)
1742   *
1743   * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing all
1744   *	supported interface types, each a flag attribute with the number
1745   *	of the interface mode.
1746   *
1747   * @NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE: Management frame subtype for
1748   *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE.
1749   *
1750   * @NL80211_ATTR_IE: Information element(s) data (used, e.g., with
1751   *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE).
1752   *
1753   * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCAN_SSIDS: number of SSIDs you can scan with
1754   *	a single scan request, a wiphy attribute.
1755   * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_SSIDS: number of SSIDs you can
1756   *	scan with a single scheduled scan request, a wiphy attribute.
1757   * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_IE_LEN: maximum length of information elements
1758   *	that can be added to a scan request
1759   * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCHED_SCAN_IE_LEN: maximum length of information
1760   *	elements that can be added to a scheduled scan request
1761   * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_MATCH_SETS: maximum number of sets that can be
1762   *	used with @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH, a wiphy attribute.
1763   *
1764   * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES: nested attribute with frequencies (in MHz)
1765   * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS: nested attribute with SSIDs, leave out for passive
1766   *	scanning and include a zero-length SSID (wildcard) for wildcard scan
1767   * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS: scan result BSS
1768   *
1769   * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR: indicates who requested the regulatory domain
1770   *	currently in effect. This could be any of the %NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_*
1771   * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE: indicates the type of the regulatory domain currently
1772   *	set. This can be one of the nl80211_reg_type (%NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_*)
1773   *
1774   * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_COMMANDS: wiphy attribute that specifies
1775   *	an array of command numbers (i.e. a mapping index to command number)
1776   *	that the driver for the given wiphy supports.
1777   *
1778   * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME: frame data (binary attribute), including frame header
1779   *	and body, but not FCS; used, e.g., with NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE and
1780   *	NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE events
1781   * @NL80211_ATTR_SSID: SSID (binary attribute, 0..32 octets)
1782   * @NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE: AuthenticationType, see &enum nl80211_auth_type,
1783   *	represented as a u32
1784   * @NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE: ReasonCode for %NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE and
1785   *	%NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE, u16
1786   *
1787   * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE: Key Type, see &enum nl80211_key_type, represented as
1788   *	a u32
1789   *
1790   * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE: A channel which has suffered a regulatory change
1791   *	due to considerations from a beacon hint. This attribute reflects
1792   *	the state of the channel _before_ the beacon hint processing. This
1793   *	attributes consists of a nested attribute containing
1794   *	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_*
1795   * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER: A channel which has suffered a regulatory change
1796   *	due to considerations from a beacon hint. This attribute reflects
1797   *	the state of the channel _after_ the beacon hint processing. This
1798   *	attributes consists of a nested attribute containing
1799   *	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_*
1800   *
1801   * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES: a set of u32 values indicating the supported
1802   *	cipher suites
1803   *
1804   * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_FIXED: a flag indicating the IBSS should not try to look
1805   *	for other networks on different channels
1806   *
1807   * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT: a flag indicating than an operation timed out; this
1808   *	is used, e.g., with %NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE event
1809   *
1810   * @NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP: Whether management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) is
1811   *	used for the association (&enum nl80211_mfp, represented as a u32);
1812   *	this attribute can be used with %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and
1813   *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests. %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL is not allowed for
1814   *	%NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE since user space SME is expected and hence, it
1815   *	must have decided whether to use management frame protection or not.
1816   *	Setting %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL with a %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT request will
1817   *	let the driver (or the firmware) decide whether to use MFP or not.
1818   *
1819   * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2: Attribute containing a
1820   *	&struct nl80211_sta_flag_update.
1821   *
1822   * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT: A flag indicating whether user space controls
1823   *	IEEE 802.1X port, i.e., sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED, in
1824   *	station mode. If the flag is included in %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE
1825   *	request, the driver will assume that the port is unauthorized until
1826   *	authorized by user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by
1827   *	default in station mode.
1828   * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE: A 16-bit value indicating the
1829   *	ethertype that will be used for key negotiation. It can be
1830   *	specified with the associate and connect commands. If it is not
1831   *	specified, the value defaults to 0x888E (PAE, 802.1X). This
1832   *	attribute is also used as a flag in the wiphy information to
1833   *	indicate that protocols other than PAE are supported.
1834   * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT: When included along with
1835   *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE, indicates that the custom
1836   *	ethertype frames used for key negotiation must not be encrypted.
1837   * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211: A flag indicating whether control
1838   *	port frames (e.g. of type given in %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE)
1839   *	will be sent directly to the network interface or sent via the NL80211
1840   *	socket.  If this attribute is missing, then legacy behavior of sending
1841   *	control port frames directly to the network interface is used.  If the
1842   *	flag is included, then control port frames are sent over NL80211 instead
1843   *	using %CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME.  If control port routing over NL80211 is
1844   *	to be used then userspace must also use the %NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER
1845   *	flag. When used with %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH, pre-auth
1846   *	frames are not forwarded over the control port.
1847   *
1848   * @NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA: Testmode data blob, passed through to the driver.
1849   *	We recommend using nested, driver-specific attributes within this.
1850   *
1851   * @NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP: A flag indicating that the DISCONNECT
1852   *	event was due to the AP disconnecting the station, and not due to
1853   *	a local disconnect request.
1854   * @NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE: StatusCode for the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
1855   *	event (u16)
1856   * @NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY: Flag attribute, used with connect(), indicating
1857   *	that protected APs should be used. This is also used with NEW_BEACON to
1858   *	indicate that the BSS is to use protection.
1859   *
1860   * @NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to
1861   *	indicate which WPA version(s) the AP we want to associate with is using
1862   *	(a u32 with flags from &enum nl80211_wpa_versions).
1863   * @NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to
1864   *	indicate which key management algorithm(s) to use (an array of u32).
1865   *	This attribute is also sent in response to @NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY,
1866   *	indicating the supported AKM suites, intended for specific drivers which
1867   *	implement SME and have constraints on which AKMs are supported and also
1868   *	the cases where an AKM support is offloaded to the driver/firmware.
1869   *	If there is no such notification from the driver, user space should
1870   *	assume the driver supports all the AKM suites.
1871   *
1872   * @NL80211_ATTR_REQ_IE: (Re)association request information elements as
1873   *	sent out by the card, for ROAM and successful CONNECT events.
1874   * @NL80211_ATTR_RESP_IE: (Re)association response information elements as
1875   *	sent by peer, for ROAM and successful CONNECT events.
1876   *
1877   * @NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID: previous BSSID, to be used in ASSOCIATE and CONNECT
1878   *	commands to specify a request to reassociate within an ESS, i.e., to use
1879   *	Reassociate Request frame (with the value of this attribute in the
1880   *	Current AP address field) instead of Association Request frame which is
1881   *	used for the initial association to an ESS.
1882   *
1883   * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY: key information in a nested attribute with
1884   *	%NL80211_KEY_* sub-attributes
1885   * @NL80211_ATTR_KEYS: array of keys for static WEP keys for connect()
1886   *	and join_ibss(), key information is in a nested attribute each
1887   *	with %NL80211_KEY_* sub-attributes
1888   *
1889   * @NL80211_ATTR_PID: Process ID of a network namespace.
1890   * @NL80211_ATTR_NETNS_FD: File descriptor of a network namespace.
1891   *
1892   * @NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION: Used to indicate consistent snapshots for
1893   *	dumps. This number increases whenever the object list being
1894   *	dumped changes, and as such userspace can verify that it has
1895   *	obtained a complete and consistent snapshot by verifying that
1896   *	all dump messages contain the same generation number. If it
1897   *	changed then the list changed and the dump should be repeated
1898   *	completely from scratch.
1899   *
1900   * @NL80211_ATTR_4ADDR: Use 4-address frames on a virtual interface
1901   *
1902   * @NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO: survey information about a channel, part of
1903   *      the survey response for %NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY, nested attribute
1904   *      containing info as possible, see &enum survey_info.
1905   *
1906   * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKID: PMK material for PMKSA caching.
1907   * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_PMKIDS: maximum number of PMKIDs a firmware can
1908   *	cache, a wiphy attribute.
1909   *
1910   * @NL80211_ATTR_DURATION: Duration of an operation in milliseconds, u32.
1911   * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_DURATION: Device attribute that
1912   *	specifies the maximum duration that can be requested with the
1913   *	remain-on-channel operation, in milliseconds, u32.
1914   *
1915   * @NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE: Generic 64-bit cookie to identify objects.
1916   *
1917   * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES: Nested set of attributes
1918   *	(enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes) describing TX rates per band. The
1919   *	enum nl80211_band value is used as the index (nla_type() of the nested
1920   *	data. If a band is not included, it will be configured to allow all
1921   *	rates based on negotiated supported rates information. This attribute
1922   *	is used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK and with starting AP,
1923   *	and joining mesh networks (not IBSS yet). In the later case, it must
1924   *	specify just a single bitrate, which is to be used for the beacon.
1925   *	The driver must also specify support for this with the extended
1926   *	features NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY,
1927   *	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT,
1928   *	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT and
1929   *	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HE.
1930   *
1931   * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_MATCH: A binary attribute which typically must contain
1932   *	at least one byte, currently used with @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME.
1933   * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE: A u16 indicating the frame type/subtype for the
1934   *	@NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME command.
1935   * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_FRAME_TYPES: wiphy capability attribute, which is a
1936   *	nested attribute of %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE attributes, containing
1937   *	information about which frame types can be transmitted with
1938   *	%NL80211_CMD_FRAME.
1939   * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_FRAME_TYPES: wiphy capability attribute, which is a
1940   *	nested attribute of %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE attributes, containing
1941   *	information about which frame types can be registered for RX.
1942   *
1943   * @NL80211_ATTR_ACK: Flag attribute indicating that the frame was
1944   *	acknowledged by the recipient.
1945   * @NL80211_ATTR_ACK_SIGNAL: Station's ack signal strength (s32)
1946   *
1947   * @NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE: powersave state, using &enum nl80211_ps_state values.
1948   *
1949   * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM: connection quality monitor configuration in a
1950   *	nested attribute with %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_* sub-attributes.
1951   *
1952   * @NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_STATE_CHANGE: Flag attribute to indicate that a command
1953   *	is requesting a local authentication/association state change without
1954   *	invoking actual management frame exchange. This can be used with
1955   *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE, NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE,
1956   *	NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE.
1957   *
1958   * @NL80211_ATTR_AP_ISOLATE: (AP mode) Do not forward traffic between stations
1959   *	connected to this BSS.
1960   *
1961   * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING: Transmit power setting type. See
1962   *      &enum nl80211_tx_power_setting for possible values.
1963   * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_LEVEL: Transmit power level in signed mBm units.
1964   *      This is used in association with @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING
1965   *      for non-automatic settings.
1966   *
1967   * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN, which mostly
1968   *	means support for per-station GTKs.
1969   *
1970   * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX: Bitmap of allowed antennas for transmitting.
1971   *	This can be used to mask out antennas which are not attached or should
1972   *	not be used for transmitting. If an antenna is not selected in this
1973   *	bitmap the hardware is not allowed to transmit on this antenna.
1974   *
1975   *	Each bit represents one antenna, starting with antenna 1 at the first
1976   *	bit. Depending on which antennas are selected in the bitmap, 802.11n
1977   *	drivers can derive which chainmasks to use (if all antennas belonging to
1978   *	a particular chain are disabled this chain should be disabled) and if
1979   *	a chain has diversity antennas whether diversity should be used or not.
1980   *	HT capabilities (STBC, TX Beamforming, Antenna selection) can be
1981   *	derived from the available chains after applying the antenna mask.
1982   *	Non-802.11n drivers can derive whether to use diversity or not.
1983   *	Drivers may reject configurations or RX/TX mask combinations they cannot
1984   *	support by returning -EINVAL.
1985   *
1986   * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_RX: Bitmap of allowed antennas for receiving.
1987   *	This can be used to mask out antennas which are not attached or should
1988   *	not be used for receiving. If an antenna is not selected in this bitmap
1989   *	the hardware should not be configured to receive on this antenna.
1990   *	For a more detailed description see @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX.
1991   *
1992   * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_TX: Bitmap of antennas which are available
1993   *	for configuration as TX antennas via the above parameters.
1994   *
1995   * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_RX: Bitmap of antennas which are available
1996   *	for configuration as RX antennas via the above parameters.
1997   *
1998   * @NL80211_ATTR_MCAST_RATE: Multicast tx rate (in 100 kbps) for IBSS
1999   *
2000   * @NL80211_ATTR_OFFCHANNEL_TX_OK: For management frame TX, the frame may be
2001   *	transmitted on another channel when the channel given doesn't match
2002   *	the current channel. If the current channel doesn't match and this
2003   *	flag isn't set, the frame will be rejected. This is also used as an
2004   *	nl80211 capability flag.
2005   *
2006   * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_HT_OPMODE: HT operation mode (u16)
2007   *
2008   * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: A nested attribute containing flags
2009   *	attributes, specifying what a key should be set as default as.
2010   *	See &enum nl80211_key_default_types.
2011   *
2012   * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_SETUP: Optional mesh setup parameters.  These cannot be
2013   *	changed once the mesh is active.
2014   * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG: Mesh configuration parameters, a nested attribute
2015   *	containing attributes from &enum nl80211_meshconf_params.
2016   * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_MESH_AUTH: Currently, this means the underlying driver
2017   *	allows auth frames in a mesh to be passed to userspace for processing via
2018   *	the @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH flag.
2019   * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_STATE: The state of a mesh peer link as defined in
2020   *	&enum nl80211_plink_state. Used when userspace is driving the peer link
2021   *	management state machine.  @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE or
2022   *	@NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM must be enabled.
2023   *
2024   * @NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED: indicates, as part of the wiphy
2025   *	capabilities, the supported WoWLAN triggers
2026   * @NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS: used by %NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN to
2027   *	indicate which WoW triggers should be enabled. This is also
2028   *	used by %NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN to get the currently enabled WoWLAN
2029   *	triggers.
2030   *
2031   * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL: Interval between scheduled scan
2032   *	cycles, in msecs.
2033   *
2034   * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH: Nested attribute with one or more
2035   *	sets of attributes to match during scheduled scans.  Only BSSs
2036   *	that match any of the sets will be reported.  These are
2037   *	pass-thru filter rules.
2038   *	For a match to succeed, the BSS must match all attributes of a
2039   *	set.  Since not every hardware supports matching all types of
2040   *	attributes, there is no guarantee that the reported BSSs are
2041   *	fully complying with the match sets and userspace needs to be
2042   *	able to ignore them by itself.
2043   *	Thus, the implementation is somewhat hardware-dependent, but
2044   *	this is only an optimization and the userspace application
2045   *	needs to handle all the non-filtered results anyway.
2046   *	If the match attributes don't make sense when combined with
2047   *	the values passed in @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS (eg. if an SSID
2048   *	is included in the probe request, but the match attributes
2049   *	will never let it go through), -EINVAL may be returned.
2050   *	If omitted, no filtering is done.
2051   *
2052   * @NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS: Nested attribute listing the supported
2053   *	interface combinations. In each nested item, it contains attributes
2054   *	defined in &enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs.
2055   *	If the wiphy uses multiple radios (@NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RADIOS is set),
2056   *	this attribute contains the interface combinations of the first radio.
2057   *	See @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS for the global wiphy
2058   *	combinations for the sum of all radios.
2059   * @NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES: Nested attribute (just like
2060   *	%NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES) containing the interface types that
2061   *	are managed in software: interfaces of these types aren't subject to
2062   *	any restrictions in their number or combinations.
2063   *
2064   * @NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA: nested attribute containing the information
2065   *	necessary for GTK rekeying in the device, see &enum nl80211_rekey_data.
2066   *
2067   * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SUPP_RATES: rates per to be advertised as supported in scan,
2068   *	nested array attribute containing an entry for each band, with the entry
2069   *	being a list of supported rates as defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but
2070   *	without the length restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES).
2071   *
2072   * @NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID: indicates whether SSID is to be hidden from Beacon
2073   *	and Probe Response (when response to wildcard Probe Request); see
2074   *	&enum nl80211_hidden_ssid, represented as a u32
2075   *
2076   * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP: Information element(s) for Probe Response frame.
2077   *	This is used with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON and %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON to
2078   *	provide extra IEs (e.g., WPS/P2P IE) into Probe Response frames when the
2079   *	driver (or firmware) replies to Probe Request frames.
2080   * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP: Information element(s) for (Re)Association
2081   *	Response frames. This is used with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON and
2082   *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON to provide extra IEs (e.g., WPS/P2P IE) into
2083   *	(Re)Association Response frames when the driver (or firmware) replies to
2084   *	(Re)Association Request frames.
2085   *
2086   * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_WME: Nested attribute containing the wme configuration
2087   *	of the station, see &enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr.
2088   * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_AP_UAPSD: the device supports uapsd when working
2089   *	as AP.
2090   *
2091   * @NL80211_ATTR_ROAM_SUPPORT: Indicates whether the firmware is capable of
2092   *	roaming to another AP in the same ESS if the signal lever is low.
2093   *
2094   * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: Nested attribute containing the PMKSA caching
2095   *	candidate information, see &enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr.
2096   *
2097   * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE: Indicates whether to use CCK rate or not
2098   *	for management frames transmission. In order to avoid p2p probe/action
2099   *	frames are being transmitted at CCK rate in 2GHz band, the user space
2100   *	applications use this attribute.
2101   *	This attribute is used with %NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN and
2102   *	%NL80211_CMD_FRAME commands.
2103   *
2104   * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION: Low level TDLS action code (e.g. link setup
2105   *	request, link setup confirm, link teardown, etc.). Values are
2106   *	described in the TDLS (802.11z) specification.
2107   * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_DIALOG_TOKEN: Non-zero token for uniquely identifying a
2108   *	TDLS conversation between two devices.
2109   * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION: High level TDLS operation; see
2110   *	&enum nl80211_tdls_operation, represented as a u8.
2111   * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_SUPPORT: A flag indicating the device can operate
2112   *	as a TDLS peer sta.
2113   * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The TDLS discovery/setup and teardown
2114   *	procedures should be performed by sending TDLS packets via
2115   *	%NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT. Otherwise %NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be
2116   *	used for asking the driver to perform a TDLS operation.
2117   *
2118   * @NL80211_ATTR_DEVICE_AP_SME: This u32 attribute may be listed for devices
2119   *	that have AP support to indicate that they have the AP SME integrated
2120   *	with support for the features listed in this attribute, see
2121   *	&enum nl80211_ap_sme_features.
2122   *
2123   * @NL80211_ATTR_DONT_WAIT_FOR_ACK: Used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME, this tells
2124   *	the driver to not wait for an acknowledgement. Note that due to this,
2125   *	it will also not give a status callback nor return a cookie. This is
2126   *	mostly useful for probe responses to save airtime.
2127   *
2128   * @NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS: This u32 attribute contains flags from
2129   *	&enum nl80211_feature_flags and is advertised in wiphy information.
2130   * @NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: Indicates that the HW responds to probe
2131   *	requests while operating in AP-mode.
2132   *	This attribute holds a bitmap of the supported protocols for
2133   *	offloading (see &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr).
2134   *
2135   * @NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response template data. Contains the entire
2136   *	probe-response frame. The DA field in the 802.11 header is zero-ed out,
2137   *	to be filled by the FW.
2138   * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HT: Force HT capable interfaces to disable
2139   *      this feature during association. This is a flag attribute.
2140   *	Currently only supported in mac80211 drivers.
2141   * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_VHT: Force VHT capable interfaces to disable
2142   *      this feature during association. This is a flag attribute.
2143   *	Currently only supported in mac80211 drivers.
2144   * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HE: Force HE capable interfaces to disable
2145   *      this feature during association. This is a flag attribute.
2146   *	Currently only supported in mac80211 drivers.
2147   * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_EHT: Force EHT capable interfaces to disable
2148   *      this feature during association. This is a flag attribute.
2149   *	Currently only supported in mac80211 drivers.
2150   * @NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY_MASK: Specify which bits of the
2151   *      ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY to which attention should be paid.
2152   *      Currently, only mac80211 NICs support this feature.
2153   *      The values that may be configured are:
2154   *       MCS rates, MAX-AMSDU, HT-20-40 and HT_CAP_SGI_40
2155   *       AMPDU density and AMPDU factor.
2156   *      All values are treated as suggestions and may be ignored
2157   *      by the driver as required.  The actual values may be seen in
2158   *      the station debugfs ht_caps file.
2159   * @NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY_MASK: Specify which bits of the
2160   *      ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY to which attention should be paid.
2161   *      Currently, only mac80211 NICs support this feature.
2162   *      All values are treated as suggestions and may be ignored
2163   *      by the driver as required.  The actual values may be seen in
2164   *      the station debugfs vht_caps file.
2165   *
2166   * @NL80211_ATTR_DFS_REGION: region for regulatory rules which this country
2167   *    abides to when initiating radiation on DFS channels. A country maps
2168   *    to one DFS region.
2169   *
2170   * @NL80211_ATTR_NOACK_MAP: This u16 bitmap contains the No Ack Policy of
2171   *      up to 16 TIDs.
2172   *
2173   * @NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT: timeout value in seconds, this can be
2174   *	used by the drivers which has MLME in firmware and does not have support
2175   *	to report per station tx/rx activity to free up the station entry from
2176   *	the list. This needs to be used when the driver advertises the
2177   *	capability to timeout the stations.
2178   *
2179   * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_SIGNAL_DBM: signal strength in dBm (as a 32-bit int);
2180   *	this attribute is (depending on the driver capabilities) added to
2181   *	received frames indicated with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME.
2182   *
2183   * @NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD: Background scan period in seconds
2184   *      or 0 to disable background scan.
2185   *
2186   * @NL80211_ATTR_USER_REG_HINT_TYPE: type of regulatory hint passed from
2187   *	userspace. If unset it is assumed the hint comes directly from
2188   *	a user. If set code could specify exactly what type of source
2189   *	was used to provide the hint. For the different types of
2190   *	allowed user regulatory hints see nl80211_user_reg_hint_type.
2191   *
2192   * @NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON: The reason for which AP has rejected
2193   *	the connection request from a station. nl80211_connect_failed_reason
2194   *	enum has different reasons of connection failure.
2195   *
2196   * @NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA: Fields and elements in Authentication frames.
2197   *	This contains the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data),
2198   *	excluding the Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the
2199   *	Authentication transaction sequence number field. It is used with
2200   *	authentication algorithms that need special fields to be added into
2201   *	the frames (SAE and FILS). Currently, only the SAE cases use the
2202   *	initial two fields (Authentication transaction sequence number and
2203   *	Status code). However, those fields are included in the attribute data
2204   *	for all authentication algorithms to keep the attribute definition
2205   *	consistent.
2206   *
2207   * @NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY: VHT Capability information element (from
2208   *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION)
2209   *
2210   * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FLAGS: scan request control flags (u32)
2211   *
2212   * @NL80211_ATTR_P2P_CTWINDOW: P2P GO Client Traffic Window (u8), used with
2213   *	the START_AP and SET_BSS commands
2214   * @NL80211_ATTR_P2P_OPPPS: P2P GO opportunistic PS (u8), used with the
2215   *	START_AP and SET_BSS commands. This can have the values 0 or 1;
2216   *	if not given in START_AP 0 is assumed, if not given in SET_BSS
2217   *	no change is made.
2218   *
2219   * @NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_MESH_POWER_MODE: local mesh STA link-specific power mode
2220   *	defined in &enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode.
2221   *
2222   * @NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY: ACL policy, see &enum nl80211_acl_policy,
2223   *	carried in a u32 attribute
2224   *
2225   * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS: Array of nested MAC addresses, used for
2226   *	MAC ACL.
2227   *
2228   * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ACL_MAX: u32 attribute to advertise the maximum
2229   *	number of MAC addresses that a device can support for MAC
2230   *	ACL.
2231   *
2232   * @NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT: Type of radar event for notification to userspace,
2233   *	contains a value of enum nl80211_radar_event (u32).
2234   *
2235   * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA: 802.11 extended capabilities that the kernel driver
2236   *	has and handles. The format is the same as the IE contents. See
2237   *	802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for more information.
2238   * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK: Extended capabilities that the kernel driver
2239   *	has set in the %NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA value, for multibit fields.
2240   *
2241   * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_CAPABILITY: Station capabilities (u16) are advertised to
2242   *	the driver, e.g., to enable TDLS power save (PU-APSD).
2243   *
2244   * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_EXT_CAPABILITY: Station extended capabilities are
2245   *	advertised to the driver, e.g., to enable TDLS off channel operations
2246   *	and PU-APSD.
2247   *
2248   * @NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES: global nl80211 feature flags, see
2249   *	&enum nl80211_protocol_features, the attribute is a u32.
2250   *
2251   * @NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP: flag attribute, userspace supports
2252   *	receiving the data for a single wiphy split across multiple
2253   *	messages, given with wiphy dump message
2254   *
2255   * @NL80211_ATTR_MDID: Mobility Domain Identifier
2256   *
2257   * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_RIC: Resource Information Container Information
2258   *	Element
2259   *
2260   * @NL80211_ATTR_CRIT_PROT_ID: critical protocol identifier requiring increased
2261   *	reliability, see &enum nl80211_crit_proto_id (u16).
2262   * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CRIT_PROT_DURATION: duration in milliseconds in which
2263   *      the connection should have increased reliability (u16).
2264   *
2265   * @NL80211_ATTR_PEER_AID: Association ID for the peer TDLS station (u16).
2266   *	This is similar to @NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID but with a difference of being
2267   *	allowed to be used with the first @NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION command to
2268   *	update a TDLS peer STA entry.
2269   *
2270   * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE: Coalesce rule information.
2271   *
2272   * @NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT: u32 attribute specifying the number of TBTT's
2273   *	until the channel switch event.
2274   * @NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX: flag attribute specifying that transmission
2275   *	must be blocked on the current channel (before the channel switch
2276   *	operation). Also included in the channel switch started event if quiet
2277   *	was requested by the AP.
2278   * @NL80211_ATTR_CSA_IES: Nested set of attributes containing the IE information
2279   *	for the time while performing a channel switch.
2280   * @NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_BEACON: An array of offsets (u16) to the channel
2281   *	switch or color change counters in the beacons tail (%NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL).
2282   * @NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_PRESP: An array of offsets (u16) to the channel
2283   *	switch or color change counters in the probe response (%NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP).
2284   *
2285   * @NL80211_ATTR_RXMGMT_FLAGS: flags for nl80211_send_mgmt(), u32.
2286   *	As specified in the &enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags.
2287   *
2288   * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_CHANNELS: array of supported channels.
2289   *
2290   * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_OPER_CLASSES: array of supported
2291   *      operating classes.
2292   *
2293   * @NL80211_ATTR_HANDLE_DFS: A flag indicating whether user space
2294   *	controls DFS operation in IBSS mode. If the flag is included in
2295   *	%NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS request, the driver will allow use of DFS
2296   *	channels and reports radar events to userspace. Userspace is required
2297   *	to react to radar events, e.g. initiate a channel switch or leave the
2298   *	IBSS network.
2299   *
2300   * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_5_MHZ: A flag indicating that the device supports
2301   *	5 MHz channel bandwidth.
2302   * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_10_MHZ: A flag indicating that the device supports
2303   *	10 MHz channel bandwidth.
2304   *
2305   * @NL80211_ATTR_OPMODE_NOTIF: Operating mode field from Operating Mode
2306   *	Notification Element based on association request when used with
2307   *	%NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION or %NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION (only when
2308   *	%NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE is supported, or with TDLS);
2309   *	u8 attribute.
2310   *
2311   * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID: The vendor ID, either a 24-bit OUI or, if
2312   *	%NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX is set, a special Linux ID (not used yet)
2313   * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD: vendor sub-command
2314   * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA: data for the vendor command, if any; this
2315   *	attribute is also used for vendor command feature advertisement
2316   * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_EVENTS: used for event list advertising in the wiphy
2317   *	info, containing a nested array of possible events
2318   *
2319   * @NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP: IP DSCP mapping for Interworking QoS mapping. This
2320   *	data is in the format defined for the payload of the QoS Map Set element
2321   *	in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97.
2322   *
2323   * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT: MAC address recommendation as initial BSS
2324   * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT: frequency of the recommended initial BSS
2325   *
2326   * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_AP_ASSOC_STA: Device attribute that indicates how many
2327   *	associated stations are supported in AP mode (including P2P GO); u32.
2328   *	Since drivers may not have a fixed limit on the maximum number (e.g.,
2329   *	other concurrent operations may affect this), drivers are allowed to
2330   *	advertise values that cannot always be met. In such cases, an attempt
2331   *	to add a new station entry with @NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION may fail.
2332   *
2333   * @NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX: An array of csa counter offsets (u16) which
2334   *	should be updated when the frame is transmitted.
2335   * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS: U8 attribute used to advertise the maximum
2336   *	supported number of csa counters.
2337   *
2338   * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_PEER_CAPABILITY: flags for TDLS peer capabilities, u32.
2339   *	As specified in the &enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability.
2340   *
2341   * @NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER: Flag attribute, if set during interface
2342   *	creation then the new interface will be owned by the netlink socket
2343   *	that created it and will be destroyed when the socket is closed.
2344   *	If set during scheduled scan start then the new scan req will be
2345   *	owned by the netlink socket that created it and the scheduled scan will
2346   *	be stopped when the socket is closed.
2347   *	If set during configuration of regulatory indoor operation then the
2348   *	regulatory indoor configuration would be owned by the netlink socket
2349   *	that configured the indoor setting, and the indoor operation would be
2350   *	cleared when the socket is closed.
2351   *	If set during NAN interface creation, the interface will be destroyed
2352   *	if the socket is closed just like any other interface. Moreover, NAN
2353   *	notifications will be sent in unicast to that socket. Without this
2354   *	attribute, the notifications will be sent to the %NL80211_MCGRP_NAN
2355   *	multicast group.
2356   *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE or %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT the
2357   *	station will deauthenticate when the socket is closed.
2358   *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS the IBSS will be automatically
2359   *	torn down when the socket is closed.
2360   *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH the mesh setup will be
2361   *	automatically torn down when the socket is closed.
2362   *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_START_AP the AP will be automatically
2363   *	disabled when the socket is closed.
2364   *
2365   * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_INITIATOR: flag attribute indicating the current end is
2366   *	the TDLS link initiator.
2367   *
2368   * @NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM: flag for indicating whether the current connection
2369   *	shall support Radio Resource Measurements (11k). This attribute can be
2370   *	used with %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests.
2371   *	User space applications are expected to use this flag only if the
2372   *	underlying device supports these minimal RRM features:
2373   *		%NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES,
2374   *		%NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET,
2375   *	Or, if global RRM is supported, see:
2376   *		%NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM
2377   *	If this flag is used, driver must add the Power Capabilities IE to the
2378   *	association request. In addition, it must also set the RRM capability
2379   *	flag in the association request's Capability Info field.
2380   *
2381   * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK: flag attribute used to enable ACK timeout
2382   *	estimation algorithm (dynack). In order to activate dynack
2383   *	%NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION feature flag must be set by lower
2384   *	drivers to indicate dynack capability. Dynack is automatically disabled
2385   *	setting valid value for coverage class.
2386   *
2387   * @NL80211_ATTR_TSID: a TSID value (u8 attribute)
2388   * @NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO: user priority value (u8 attribute)
2389   * @NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME: admitted time in units of 32 microseconds
2390   *	(per second) (u16 attribute)
2391   *
2392   * @NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE: SMPS mode to use (ap mode). see
2393   *	&enum nl80211_smps_mode.
2394   *
2395   * @NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS: operating class
2396   *
2397   * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK: MAC address mask
2398   *
2399   * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG: flag attribute indicating this device
2400   *	is self-managing its regulatory information and any regulatory domain
2401   *	obtained from it is coming from the device's wiphy and not the global
2402   *	cfg80211 regdomain.
2403   *
2404   * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_FEATURES: extended feature flags contained in a byte
2405   *	array. The feature flags are identified by their bit index (see &enum
2406   *	nl80211_ext_feature_index). The bit index is ordered starting at the
2407   *	least-significant bit of the first byte in the array, ie. bit index 0
2408   *	is located at bit 0 of byte 0. bit index 25 would be located at bit 1
2409   *	of byte 3 (u8 array).
2410   *
2411   * @NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_RADIO_STATS: Request overall radio statistics to be
2412   *	returned along with other survey data. If set, @NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY
2413   *	may return a survey entry without a channel indicating global radio
2414   *	statistics (only some values are valid and make sense.)
2415   *	For devices that don't return such an entry even then, the information
2416   *	should be contained in the result as the sum of the respective counters
2417   *	over all channels.
2418   *
2419   * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY: delay before the first cycle of a
2420   *	scheduled scan is started.  Or the delay before a WoWLAN
2421   *	net-detect scan is started, counting from the moment the
2422   *	system is suspended.  This value is a u32, in seconds.
2423   *
2424   * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_INDOOR: flag attribute, if set indicates that the device
2425   *      is operating in an indoor environment.
2426   *
2427   * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS: maximum number of scan plans for
2428   *	scheduled scan supported by the device (u32), a wiphy attribute.
2429   * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL: maximum interval (in seconds) for
2430   *	a scan plan (u32), a wiphy attribute.
2431   * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS: maximum number of iterations in
2432   *	a scan plan (u32), a wiphy attribute.
2433   * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS: a list of scan plans for scheduled scan.
2434   *	Each scan plan defines the number of scan iterations and the interval
2435   *	between scans. The last scan plan will always run infinitely,
2436   *	thus it must not specify the number of iterations, only the interval
2437   *	between scans. The scan plans are executed sequentially.
2438   *	Each scan plan is a nested attribute of &enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan.
2439   * @NL80211_ATTR_PBSS: flag attribute. If set it means operate
2440   *	in a PBSS. Specified in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to request
2441   *	connecting to a PCP, and in %NL80211_CMD_START_AP to start
2442   *	a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG networks only.
2443   * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT: nested attribute for driver supporting the
2444   *	BSS selection feature. When used with %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY it contains
2445   *	attributes according &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr to indicate what
2446   *	BSS selection behaviours are supported. When used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
2447   *	it contains the behaviour-specific attribute containing the parameters for
2448   *	BSS selection to be done by driver and/or firmware.
2449   *
2450   * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORT_P2P_PS: whether P2P PS mechanism supported
2451   *	or not. u8, one of the values of &enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status
2452   *
2453   * @NL80211_ATTR_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
2454   *
2455   * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_EXT_CAPA: Nested attribute of the following attributes:
2456   *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE, %NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA,
2457   *	%NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK, to specify the extended capabilities and
2458   *	other interface-type specific capabilities per interface type. For MLO,
2459   *	%NL80211_ATTR_EML_CAPABILITY and %NL80211_ATTR_MLD_CAPA_AND_OPS are
2460   *	present.
2461   *
2462   * @NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA: array of 24 bytes that defines a MU-MIMO
2463   *	groupID for monitor mode.
2464   *	The first 8 bytes are a mask that defines the membership in each
2465   *	group (there are 64 groups, group 0 and 63 are reserved),
2466   *	each bit represents a group and set to 1 for being a member in
2467   *	that group and 0 for not being a member.
2468   *	The remaining 16 bytes define the position in each group: 2 bits for
2469   *	each group.
2470   *	(smaller group numbers represented on most significant bits and bigger
2471   *	group numbers on least significant bits.)
2472   *	This attribute is used only if all interfaces are in monitor mode.
2473   *	Set this attribute in order to monitor packets using the given MU-MIMO
2474   *	groupID data.
2475   *	to turn off that feature set all the bits of the groupID to zero.
2476   * @NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR: mac address for the sniffer to follow
2477   *	when using MU-MIMO air sniffer.
2478   *	to turn that feature off set an invalid mac address
2479   *	(e.g. FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF)
2480   *
2481   * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF: The time at which the scan was actually
2482   *	started (u64). The time is the TSF of the BSS the interface that
2483   *	requested the scan is connected to (if available, otherwise this
2484   *	attribute must not be included).
2485   * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF_BSSID: The BSS according to which
2486   *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF is set.
2487   * @NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION: measurement duration in TUs (u16). If
2488   *	%NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY is not set, this is the
2489   *	maximum measurement duration allowed. This attribute is used with
2490   *	measurement requests. It can also be used with %NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN
2491   *	if the scan is used for beacon report radio measurement.
2492   * @NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY: flag attribute that indicates
2493   *	that the duration specified with %NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION is
2494   *	mandatory. If this flag is not set, the duration is the maximum duration
2495   *	and the actual measurement duration may be shorter.
2496   *
2497   * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PEER_AID: Association ID for the mesh peer (u16). This is
2498   *	used to pull the stored data for mesh peer in power save state.
2499   *
2500   * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF: the master preference to be used by
2501   *	%NL80211_CMD_START_NAN and optionally with
2502   *	%NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG. Its type is u8 and it can't be 0.
2503   *	Also, values 1 and 255 are reserved for certification purposes and
2504   *	should not be used during a normal device operation.
2505   * @NL80211_ATTR_BANDS: operating bands configuration.  This is a u32
2506   *	bitmask of BIT(NL80211_BAND_*) as described in %enum
2507   *	nl80211_band.  For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0
2508   *	would be set.  This attribute is used with
2509   *	%NL80211_CMD_START_NAN and %NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG, and
2510   *	it is optional.  If no bands are set, it means don't-care and
2511   *	the device will decide what to use.
2512   * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC: a function that can be added to NAN. See
2513   *	&enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes for description of this nested
2514   *	attribute.
2515   * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH: used to report a match. This is a nested attribute.
2516   *	See &enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes.
2517   * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK: KEK for FILS (Re)Association Request/Response frame
2518   *	protection.
2519   * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES: Nonces (part of AAD) for FILS (Re)Association
2520   *	Request/Response frame protection. This attribute contains the 16 octet
2521   *	STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce.
2522   *
2523   * @NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED: Indicates whether or not multicast
2524   *	packets should be send out as unicast to all stations (flag attribute).
2525   *
2526   * @NL80211_ATTR_BSSID: The BSSID of the AP. Note that %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is also
2527   *	used in various commands/events for specifying the BSSID.
2528   *
2529   * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI: Relative RSSI threshold by which
2530   *	other BSSs has to be better or slightly worse than the current
2531   *	connected BSS so that they get reported to user space.
2532   *	This will give an opportunity to userspace to consider connecting to
2533   *	other matching BSSs which have better or slightly worse RSSI than
2534   *	the current connected BSS by using an offloaded operation to avoid
2535   *	unnecessary wakeups.
2536   *
2537   * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for BSSs in
2538   *	the specified band is to be adjusted before doing
2539   *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI based comparison to figure out
2540   *	better BSSs. The attribute value is a packed structure
2541   *	value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust.
2542   *
2543   * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT_REASON: The reason for which an operation timed out.
2544   *	u32 attribute with an &enum nl80211_timeout_reason value. This is used,
2545   *	e.g., with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT event.
2546   *
2547   * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME: EAP Re-authentication Protocol (ERP)
2548   *	username part of NAI used to refer keys rRK and rIK. This is used with
2549   *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2550   *
2551   * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM: EAP Re-authentication Protocol (ERP) realm part
2552   *	of NAI specifying the domain name of the ER server. This is used with
2553   *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2554   *
2555   * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM: Unsigned 16-bit ERP next sequence number
2556   *	to use in ERP messages. This is used in generating the FILS wrapped data
2557   *	for FILS authentication and is used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2558   *
2559   * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) for the
2560   *	NAI specified by %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME and
2561   *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM. This is used for generating rIK and rMSK
2562   *	from successful FILS authentication and is used with
2563   *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2564   *
2565   * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID: A 2-octet identifier advertised by a FILS AP
2566   *	identifying the scope of PMKSAs. This is used with
2567   *	@NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA and @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA.
2568   *
2569   * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK: attribute for passing PMK key material. Used with
2570   *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA for the PMKSA identified by %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID.
2571   *	For %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and %NL80211_CMD_START_AP it is used to provide
2572   *	PSK for offloading 4-way handshake for WPA/WPA2-PSK networks. For 802.1X
2573   *	authentication it is used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK. For offloaded FT
2574   *	support this attribute specifies the PMK-R0 if NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME
2575   *	is included as well.
2576   *
2577   * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI: flag attribute which user-space shall use to
2578   *	indicate that it supports multiple active scheduled scan requests.
2579   * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MAX_REQS: indicates maximum number of scheduled
2580   *	scan request that may be active for the device (u32).
2581   *
2582   * @NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS: flag attribute which user-space can include
2583   *	in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to indicate that for 802.1X authentication it
2584   *	wants to use the supported offload of the 4-way handshake.
2585   * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME: PMK-R0 Name for offloaded FT.
2586   * @NL80211_ATTR_PORT_AUTHORIZED: (reserved)
2587   *
2588   * @NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION: Identify the requested external
2589   *     authentication operation (u32 attribute with an
2590   *     &enum nl80211_external_auth_action value). This is used with the
2591   *     %NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH request event.
2592   * @NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: Flag attribute indicating that the user
2593   *	space supports external authentication. This attribute shall be used
2594   *	with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and %NL80211_CMD_START_AP request. The driver
2595   *	may offload authentication processing to user space if this capability
2596   *	is indicated in the respective requests from the user space. (This flag
2597   *	attribute deprecated for %NL80211_CMD_START_AP, use
2598   *	%NL80211_ATTR_AP_SETTINGS_FLAGS)
2599   *
2600   * @NL80211_ATTR_NSS: Station's New/updated  RX_NSS value notified using this
2601   *	u8 attribute. This is used with %NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED.
2602   *
2603   * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_STATS: TXQ statistics (nested attribute, see &enum
2604   *      nl80211_txq_stats)
2605   * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_LIMIT: Total packet limit for the TXQ queues for this phy.
2606   *      The smaller of this and the memory limit is enforced.
2607   * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: Total memory limit (in bytes) for the
2608   *      TXQ queues for this phy. The smaller of this and the packet limit is
2609   *      enforced.
2610   * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum (bytes). Number of bytes
2611   *      a flow is assigned on each round of the DRR scheduler.
2612   * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_CAPABILITY: HE Capability information element (from
2613   *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION). Can be set
2614   *	only if %NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME is set.
2615   *
2616   * @NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER: nested attribute which user-space can include
2617   *	in %NL80211_CMD_START_AP or %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON for fine timing
2618   *	measurement (FTM) responder functionality and containing parameters as
2619   *	possible, see &enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attr
2620   *
2621   * @NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS: Nested attribute with FTM responder
2622   *	statistics, see &enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats.
2623   *
2624   * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT: Timeout for the given operation in milliseconds (u32),
2625   *	if the attribute is not given no timeout is requested. Note that 0 is an
2626   *	invalid value.
2627   *
2628   * @NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS: peer measurements request (and result)
2629   *	data, uses nested attributes specified in
2630   *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs.
2631   *	This is also used for capability advertisement in the wiphy information,
2632   *	with the appropriate sub-attributes.
2633   *
2634   * @NL80211_ATTR_AIRTIME_WEIGHT: Station's weight when scheduled by the airtime
2635   *	scheduler.
2636   *
2637   * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER_SETTING: Transmit power setting type (u8) for
2638   *	station associated with the AP. See &enum nl80211_tx_power_setting for
2639   *	possible values.
2640   * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER: Transmit power level (s16) in dBm units. This
2641   *	allows to set Tx power for a station. If this attribute is not included,
2642   *	the default per-interface tx power setting will be overriding. Driver
2643   *	should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx power per-interface
2644   *	or per-station.
2645   *
2646   * @NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD: attribute for passing SAE password material. It
2647   *	is used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to provide password for offloading
2648   *	SAE authentication for WPA3-Personal networks.
2649   *
2650   * @NL80211_ATTR_TWT_RESPONDER: Enable target wait time responder support.
2651   *
2652   * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_OBSS_PD: nested attribute for OBSS Packet Detection
2653   *	functionality.
2654   *
2655   * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_CHANNELS: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz
2656   *	channel(s) that are allowed to be used for EDMG transmissions.
2657   *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251. (u8 attribute)
2658   * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_BW_CONFIG: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes
2659   *	the allowed channel bandwidth configurations. (u8 attribute)
2660   *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251, Table 13.
2661   *
2662   * @NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID: VLAN ID (1..4094) for the station and VLAN group key
2663   *	(u16).
2664   *
2665   * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_BSS_COLOR: nested attribute for BSS Color Settings.
2666   *
2667   * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_AKM_SUITES: nested array attribute, with each entry
2668   *	using attributes from &enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes. This
2669   *	attribute is sent in a response to %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY indicating
2670   *	supported AKM suites capability per interface. AKMs advertised in
2671   *	%NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES are default capabilities if AKM suites not
2672   *	advertised for a specific interface type.
2673   *
2674   * @NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG: TID specific configuration in a
2675   *	nested attribute with &enum nl80211_tid_config_attr sub-attributes;
2676   *	on output (in wiphy attributes) it contains only the feature sub-
2677   *	attributes.
2678   *
2679   * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH: disable preauth frame rx on control
2680   *	port in order to forward/receive them as ordinary data frames.
2681   *
2682   * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK_LIFETIME: Maximum lifetime for PMKSA in seconds (u32,
2683   *	dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold; 0 is not a valid value).
2684   *	An optional parameter configured through %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA.
2685   *	Drivers that trigger roaming need to know the lifetime of the
2686   *	configured PMKSA for triggering the full vs. PMKSA caching based
2687   *	authentication. This timeout helps authentication methods like SAE,
2688   *	where PMK gets updated only by going through a full (new SAE)
2689   *	authentication instead of getting updated during an association for EAP
2690   *	authentication. No new full authentication within the PMK expiry shall
2691   *	result in a disassociation at the end of the lifetime.
2692   *
2693   * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK_REAUTH_THRESHOLD: Reauthentication threshold time, in
2694   *	terms of percentage of %NL80211_ATTR_PMK_LIFETIME
2695   *	(u8, dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold, 1..100). This is an optional
2696   *	parameter configured through %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA. Requests the
2697   *	driver to trigger a full authentication roam (without PMKSA caching)
2698   *	after the reauthentication threshold time, but before the PMK lifetime
2699   *	has expired.
2700   *
2701   *	Authentication methods like SAE need to be able to generate a new PMKSA
2702   *	entry without having to force a disconnection after the PMK timeout. If
2703   *	no roaming occurs between the reauth threshold and PMK expiration,
2704   *	disassociation is still forced.
2705   * @NL80211_ATTR_RECEIVE_MULTICAST: multicast flag for the
2706   *	%NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME command, see the description there.
2707   * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET: offset of the associated
2708   *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ in positive KHz. Only valid when supplied with
2709   *	an %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET.
2710   * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1_OFFSET: Center frequency offset in KHz for the
2711   *	first channel segment specified in %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1.
2712   * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ: nested attribute with KHz frequencies
2713   *
2714   * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPABILITY: HE 6 GHz Band Capability element (from
2715   *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION).
2716   *
2717   * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_DISCOVERY: Optional parameter to configure FILS
2718   *	discovery. It is a nested attribute, see
2719   *	&enum nl80211_fils_discovery_attributes. Userspace should pass an empty
2720   *	nested attribute to disable this feature and delete the templates.
2721   *
2722   * @NL80211_ATTR_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Optional parameter to configure
2723   *	unsolicited broadcast probe response. It is a nested attribute, see
2724   *	&enum nl80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_attributes. Userspace should pass an empty
2725   *	nested attribute to disable this feature and delete the templates.
2726   *
2727   * @NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY: S1G Capability information element (from
2728   *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION)
2729   * @NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY_MASK: S1G Capability Information element
2730   *	override mask. Used with NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY in
2731   *	NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE or NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2732   *
2733   * @NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PWE: Indicates the mechanism(s) allowed for SAE PWE
2734   *	derivation in WPA3-Personal networks which are using SAE authentication.
2735   *	This is a u8 attribute that encapsulates one of the values from
2736   *	&enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism.
2737   *
2738   * @NL80211_ATTR_SAR_SPEC: SAR power limitation specification when
2739   *	used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPECS. The message contains fields
2740   *	of %nl80211_sar_attrs which specifies the sar type and related
2741   *	sar specs. Sar specs contains array of %nl80211_sar_specs_attrs.
2742   *
2743   * @NL80211_ATTR_RECONNECT_REQUESTED: flag attribute, used with deauth and
2744   *	disassoc events to indicate that an immediate reconnect to the AP
2745   *	is desired.
2746   *
2747   * @NL80211_ATTR_OBSS_COLOR_BITMAP: bitmap of the u64 BSS colors for the
2748   *	%NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION event.
2749   *
2750   * @NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COUNT: u8 attribute specifying the number of TBTT's
2751   *	until the color switch event.
2752   * @NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COLOR: u8 attribute specifying the color that we are
2753   *	switching to
2754   * @NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_ELEMS: Nested set of attributes containing the IE
2755   *	information for the time while performing a color switch.
2756   *
2757   * @NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_CONFIG: Nested attribute for multiple BSSID
2758   *	advertisements (MBSSID) parameters in AP mode.
2759   *	Kernel uses this attribute to indicate the driver's support for MBSSID
2760   *	and enhanced multi-BSSID advertisements (EMA AP) to the userspace.
2761   *	Userspace should use this attribute to configure per interface MBSSID
2762   *	parameters.
2763   *	See &enum nl80211_mbssid_config_attributes for details.
2764   *
2765   * @NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS: Nested parameter to pass multiple BSSID elements.
2766   *	Mandatory parameter for the transmitting interface to enable MBSSID.
2767   *	Optional for the non-transmitting interfaces.
2768   *
2769   * @NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_BACKGROUND: Configure dedicated offchannel chain
2770   *	available for radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used
2771   *	to transmit or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
2772   *	Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
2773   *	switching on a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
2774   *	radar channel.
2775   *
2776   * @NL80211_ATTR_AP_SETTINGS_FLAGS: u32 attribute contains ap settings flags,
2777   *	enumerated in &enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags. This attribute shall be
2778   *	used with %NL80211_CMD_START_AP request.
2779   *
2780   * @NL80211_ATTR_EHT_CAPABILITY: EHT Capability information element (from
2781   *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION). Can be set
2782   *	only if %NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME is set.
2783   *
2784   * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID: A (u8) link ID for use with MLO, to be used with
2785   *	various commands that need a link ID to operate.
2786   * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS: A nested array of links, each containing some
2787   *	per-link information and a link ID.
2788   * @NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR: An MLD address, used with various commands such as
2789   *	authenticate/associate.
2790   *
2791   * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT: Flag attribute to indicate user space supports MLO
2792   *	connection. Used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. If this attribute is not
2793   *	included in NL80211_CMD_CONNECT drivers must not perform MLO connection.
2794   *
2795   * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES: U16 attribute. Indicates maximum number of
2796   *	AKM suites allowed for %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT, %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and
2797   *	%NL80211_CMD_START_AP in %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY response. If this
2798   *	attribute is not present userspace shall consider maximum number of AKM
2799   *	suites allowed as %NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES which is the legacy maximum
2800   *	number prior to the introduction of this attribute.
2801   *
2802   * @NL80211_ATTR_EML_CAPABILITY: EML Capability information (u16)
2803   * @NL80211_ATTR_MLD_CAPA_AND_OPS: MLD Capabilities and Operations (u16)
2804   *
2805   * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP: Hardware timestamp for TX operation in
2806   *	nanoseconds (u64). This is the device clock timestamp so it will
2807   *	probably reset when the device is stopped or the firmware is reset.
2808   *	When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS, indicates the frame TX
2809   *	timestamp. When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME RX notification, indicates
2810   *	the ack TX timestamp.
2811   * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP: Hardware timestamp for RX operation in
2812   *	nanoseconds (u64). This is the device clock timestamp so it will
2813   *	probably reset when the device is stopped or the firmware is reset.
2814   *	When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS, indicates the ack RX
2815   *	timestamp. When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME RX notification, indicates
2816   *	the incoming frame RX timestamp.
2817   * @NL80211_ATTR_TD_BITMAP: Transition Disable bitmap, for subsequent
2818   *	(re)associations.
2819   *
2820   * @NL80211_ATTR_PUNCT_BITMAP: (u32) Preamble puncturing bitmap, lowest
2821   *	bit corresponds to the lowest 20 MHz channel. Each bit set to 1
2822   *	indicates that the sub-channel is punctured. Higher 16 bits are
2823   *	reserved.
2824   *
2825   * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_HW_TIMESTAMP_PEERS: Maximum number of peers that HW
2826   *	timestamping can be enabled for concurrently (u16), a wiphy attribute.
2827   *	A value of 0xffff indicates setting for all peers (i.e. not specifying
2828   *	an address with %NL80211_CMD_SET_HW_TIMESTAMP) is supported.
2829   * @NL80211_ATTR_HW_TIMESTAMP_ENABLED: Indicates whether HW timestamping should
2830   *	be enabled or not (flag attribute).
2831   *
2832   * @NL80211_ATTR_EMA_RNR_ELEMS: Optional nested attribute for
2833   *	reduced neighbor report (RNR) elements. This attribute can be used
2834   *	only when NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_EMA is enabled.
2835   *	Userspace is responsible for splitting the RNR into multiple
2836   *	elements such that each element excludes the non-transmitting
2837   *	profiles already included in the MBSSID element
2838   *	(%NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS) at the same index. Each EMA beacon
2839   *	will be generated by adding MBSSID and RNR elements at the same
2840   *	index. If the userspace includes more RNR elements than number of
2841   *	MBSSID elements then these will be added in every EMA beacon.
2842   *
2843   * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_DISABLED: Flag attribute indicating that the link is
2844   *	disabled.
2845   *
2846   * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_DUMP_INCLUDE_USE_DATA: Include BSS usage data, i.e.
2847   *	include BSSes that can only be used in restricted scenarios and/or
2848   *	cannot be used at all.
2849   *
2850   * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_TTLM_DLINK: Binary attribute specifying the downlink TID to
2851   *      link mapping. The length is 8 * sizeof(u16). For each TID the link
2852   *      mapping is as defined in section 9.4.2.314 (TID-To-Link Mapping element)
2853   *      in Draft P802.11be_D4.0.
2854   * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_TTLM_ULINK: Binary attribute specifying the uplink TID to
2855   *      link mapping. The length is 8 * sizeof(u16). For each TID the link
2856   *      mapping is as defined in section 9.4.2.314 (TID-To-Link Mapping element)
2857   *      in Draft P802.11be_D4.0.
2858   *
2859   * @NL80211_ATTR_ASSOC_SPP_AMSDU: flag attribute used with
2860   *	%NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE indicating the SPP A-MSDUs
2861   *	are used on this connection
2862   *
2863   * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RADIOS: Nested attribute describing physical radios
2864   *	belonging to this wiphy. See &enum nl80211_wiphy_radio_attrs.
2865   *
2866   * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS: Nested attribute listing the
2867   *	supported interface combinations for all radios combined. In each
2868   *	nested item, it contains attributes defined in
2869   *	&enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs.
2870   *
2871   * @NUM_NL80211_ATTR: total number of nl80211_attrs available
2872   * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number currently defined
2873   * @__NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
2874   */
2875  enum nl80211_attrs {
2876  /* don't change the order or add anything between, this is ABI! */
2877  	NL80211_ATTR_UNSPEC,
2878  
2879  	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY,
2880  	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME,
2881  
2882  	NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX,
2883  	NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME,
2884  	NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE,
2885  
2886  	NL80211_ATTR_MAC,
2887  
2888  	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA,
2889  	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX,
2890  	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER,
2891  	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ,
2892  	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT,
2893  
2894  	NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL,
2895  	NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD,
2896  	NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD,
2897  	NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL,
2898  
2899  	NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID,
2900  	NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS,
2901  	NL80211_ATTR_STA_LISTEN_INTERVAL,
2902  	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_RATES,
2903  	NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN,
2904  	NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO,
2905  
2906  	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_BANDS,
2907  
2908  	NL80211_ATTR_MNTR_FLAGS,
2909  
2910  	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_ID,
2911  	NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_ACTION,
2912  	NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP,
2913  	NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO,
2914  
2915  	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_CTS_PROT,
2916  	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_PREAMBLE,
2917  	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME,
2918  
2919  	NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY,
2920  
2921  	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES,
2922  
2923  	NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2,
2924  	NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULES,
2925  
2926  	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG,
2927  
2928  	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES,
2929  
2930  	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS,
2931  	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ,
2932  	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE,
2933  
2934  	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT,
2935  
2936  	NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE,
2937  	NL80211_ATTR_IE,
2938  
2939  	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCAN_SSIDS,
2940  
2941  	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES,
2942  	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS,
2943  	NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION, /* replaces old SCAN_GENERATION */
2944  	NL80211_ATTR_BSS,
2945  
2946  	NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR,
2947  	NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE,
2948  
2949  	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_COMMANDS,
2950  
2951  	NL80211_ATTR_FRAME,
2952  	NL80211_ATTR_SSID,
2953  	NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE,
2954  	NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE,
2955  
2956  	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE,
2957  
2958  	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_IE_LEN,
2959  	NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES,
2960  
2961  	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE,
2962  	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER,
2963  
2964  	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_FIXED,
2965  
2966  
2967  	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT,
2968  	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG,
2969  	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD,
2970  	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD,
2971  
2972  	NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT,
2973  
2974  	NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP,
2975  
2976  	NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2,
2977  
2978  	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT,
2979  
2980  	NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA,
2981  
2982  	NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY,
2983  
2984  	NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP,
2985  	NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE,
2986  
2987  	NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE,
2988  	NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP,
2989  	NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS,
2990  	NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES,
2991  
2992  	NL80211_ATTR_REQ_IE,
2993  	NL80211_ATTR_RESP_IE,
2994  
2995  	NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID,
2996  
2997  	NL80211_ATTR_KEY,
2998  	NL80211_ATTR_KEYS,
2999  
3000  	NL80211_ATTR_PID,
3001  
3002  	NL80211_ATTR_4ADDR,
3003  
3004  	NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO,
3005  
3006  	NL80211_ATTR_PMKID,
3007  	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_PMKIDS,
3008  
3009  	NL80211_ATTR_DURATION,
3010  
3011  	NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE,
3012  
3013  	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_COVERAGE_CLASS,
3014  
3015  	NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES,
3016  
3017  	NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_MATCH,
3018  
3019  	NL80211_ATTR_ACK,
3020  
3021  	NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE,
3022  
3023  	NL80211_ATTR_CQM,
3024  
3025  	NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_STATE_CHANGE,
3026  
3027  	NL80211_ATTR_AP_ISOLATE,
3028  
3029  	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING,
3030  	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_LEVEL,
3031  
3032  	NL80211_ATTR_TX_FRAME_TYPES,
3033  	NL80211_ATTR_RX_FRAME_TYPES,
3034  	NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE,
3035  
3036  	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE,
3037  	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT,
3038  
3039  	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_IBSS_RSN,
3040  
3041  	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX,
3042  	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_RX,
3043  
3044  	NL80211_ATTR_MCAST_RATE,
3045  
3046  	NL80211_ATTR_OFFCHANNEL_TX_OK,
3047  
3048  	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_HT_OPMODE,
3049  
3050  	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES,
3051  
3052  	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_DURATION,
3053  
3054  	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_SETUP,
3055  
3056  	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_TX,
3057  	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_RX,
3058  
3059  	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_MESH_AUTH,
3060  	NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_STATE,
3061  
3062  	NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS,
3063  	NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED,
3064  
3065  	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL,
3066  
3067  	NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS,
3068  	NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES,
3069  
3070  	NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA,
3071  
3072  	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_SSIDS,
3073  	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCHED_SCAN_IE_LEN,
3074  
3075  	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SUPP_RATES,
3076  
3077  	NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID,
3078  
3079  	NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP,
3080  	NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP,
3081  
3082  	NL80211_ATTR_STA_WME,
3083  	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_AP_UAPSD,
3084  
3085  	NL80211_ATTR_ROAM_SUPPORT,
3086  
3087  	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH,
3088  	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_MATCH_SETS,
3089  
3090  	NL80211_ATTR_PMKSA_CANDIDATE,
3091  
3092  	NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE,
3093  
3094  	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION,
3095  	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_DIALOG_TOKEN,
3096  	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION,
3097  	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_SUPPORT,
3098  	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP,
3099  
3100  	NL80211_ATTR_DEVICE_AP_SME,
3101  
3102  	NL80211_ATTR_DONT_WAIT_FOR_ACK,
3103  
3104  	NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS,
3105  
3106  	NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD,
3107  
3108  	NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP,
3109  
3110  	NL80211_ATTR_DFS_REGION,
3111  
3112  	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HT,
3113  	NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY_MASK,
3114  
3115  	NL80211_ATTR_NOACK_MAP,
3116  
3117  	NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT,
3118  
3119  	NL80211_ATTR_RX_SIGNAL_DBM,
3120  
3121  	NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD,
3122  
3123  	NL80211_ATTR_WDEV,
3124  
3125  	NL80211_ATTR_USER_REG_HINT_TYPE,
3126  
3127  	NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON,
3128  
3129  	NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA,
3130  
3131  	NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY,
3132  
3133  	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FLAGS,
3134  
3135  	NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH,
3136  	NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1,
3137  	NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2,
3138  
3139  	NL80211_ATTR_P2P_CTWINDOW,
3140  	NL80211_ATTR_P2P_OPPPS,
3141  
3142  	NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_MESH_POWER_MODE,
3143  
3144  	NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY,
3145  
3146  	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS,
3147  
3148  	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ACL_MAX,
3149  
3150  	NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT,
3151  
3152  	NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA,
3153  	NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK,
3154  
3155  	NL80211_ATTR_STA_CAPABILITY,
3156  	NL80211_ATTR_STA_EXT_CAPABILITY,
3157  
3158  	NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES,
3159  	NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP,
3160  
3161  	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_VHT,
3162  	NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY_MASK,
3163  
3164  	NL80211_ATTR_MDID,
3165  	NL80211_ATTR_IE_RIC,
3166  
3167  	NL80211_ATTR_CRIT_PROT_ID,
3168  	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CRIT_PROT_DURATION,
3169  
3170  	NL80211_ATTR_PEER_AID,
3171  
3172  	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE,
3173  
3174  	NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT,
3175  	NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX,
3176  	NL80211_ATTR_CSA_IES,
3177  	NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_BEACON,
3178  	NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_PRESP,
3179  
3180  	NL80211_ATTR_RXMGMT_FLAGS,
3181  
3182  	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_CHANNELS,
3183  
3184  	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_OPER_CLASSES,
3185  
3186  	NL80211_ATTR_HANDLE_DFS,
3187  
3188  	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_5_MHZ,
3189  	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_10_MHZ,
3190  
3191  	NL80211_ATTR_OPMODE_NOTIF,
3192  
3193  	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID,
3194  	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD,
3195  	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
3196  	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_EVENTS,
3197  
3198  	NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP,
3199  
3200  	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT,
3201  	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT,
3202  
3203  	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_AP_ASSOC_STA,
3204  
3205  	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_PEER_CAPABILITY,
3206  
3207  	NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER,
3208  
3209  	NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX,
3210  	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS,
3211  
3212  	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_INITIATOR,
3213  
3214  	NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM,
3215  
3216  	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK,
3217  
3218  	NL80211_ATTR_TSID,
3219  	NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO,
3220  	NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME,
3221  
3222  	NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE,
3223  
3224  	NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS,
3225  
3226  	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK,
3227  
3228  	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG,
3229  
3230  	NL80211_ATTR_EXT_FEATURES,
3231  
3232  	NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_RADIO_STATS,
3233  
3234  	NL80211_ATTR_NETNS_FD,
3235  
3236  	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY,
3237  
3238  	NL80211_ATTR_REG_INDOOR,
3239  
3240  	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS,
3241  	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL,
3242  	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS,
3243  	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS,
3244  
3245  	NL80211_ATTR_PBSS,
3246  
3247  	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT,
3248  
3249  	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORT_P2P_PS,
3250  
3251  	NL80211_ATTR_PAD,
3252  
3253  	NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_EXT_CAPA,
3254  
3255  	NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA,
3256  	NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR,
3257  
3258  	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF,
3259  	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF_BSSID,
3260  	NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION,
3261  	NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY,
3262  
3263  	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PEER_AID,
3264  
3265  	NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF,
3266  	NL80211_ATTR_BANDS,
3267  	NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC,
3268  	NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH,
3269  
3270  	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK,
3271  	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES,
3272  
3273  	NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED,
3274  
3275  	NL80211_ATTR_BSSID,
3276  
3277  	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI,
3278  	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RSSI_ADJUST,
3279  
3280  	NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT_REASON,
3281  
3282  	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME,
3283  	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM,
3284  	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM,
3285  	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK,
3286  	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID,
3287  
3288  	NL80211_ATTR_PMK,
3289  
3290  	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI,
3291  	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MAX_REQS,
3292  
3293  	NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS,
3294  	NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME,
3295  	NL80211_ATTR_PORT_AUTHORIZED,
3296  
3297  	NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION,
3298  	NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT,
3299  
3300  	NL80211_ATTR_NSS,
3301  	NL80211_ATTR_ACK_SIGNAL,
3302  
3303  	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211,
3304  
3305  	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_STATS,
3306  	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_LIMIT,
3307  	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT,
3308  	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_QUANTUM,
3309  
3310  	NL80211_ATTR_HE_CAPABILITY,
3311  
3312  	NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER,
3313  
3314  	NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS,
3315  
3316  	NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT,
3317  
3318  	NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS,
3319  
3320  	NL80211_ATTR_AIRTIME_WEIGHT,
3321  	NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER_SETTING,
3322  	NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER,
3323  
3324  	NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD,
3325  
3326  	NL80211_ATTR_TWT_RESPONDER,
3327  
3328  	NL80211_ATTR_HE_OBSS_PD,
3329  
3330  	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_CHANNELS,
3331  	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_BW_CONFIG,
3332  
3333  	NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID,
3334  
3335  	NL80211_ATTR_HE_BSS_COLOR,
3336  
3337  	NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_AKM_SUITES,
3338  
3339  	NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG,
3340  
3341  	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH,
3342  
3343  	NL80211_ATTR_PMK_LIFETIME,
3344  	NL80211_ATTR_PMK_REAUTH_THRESHOLD,
3345  
3346  	NL80211_ATTR_RECEIVE_MULTICAST,
3347  	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET,
3348  	NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1_OFFSET,
3349  	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ,
3350  
3351  	NL80211_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPABILITY,
3352  
3353  	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_DISCOVERY,
3354  
3355  	NL80211_ATTR_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP,
3356  
3357  	NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY,
3358  	NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY_MASK,
3359  
3360  	NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PWE,
3361  
3362  	NL80211_ATTR_RECONNECT_REQUESTED,
3363  
3364  	NL80211_ATTR_SAR_SPEC,
3365  
3366  	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HE,
3367  
3368  	NL80211_ATTR_OBSS_COLOR_BITMAP,
3369  
3370  	NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COUNT,
3371  	NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COLOR,
3372  	NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_ELEMS,
3373  
3374  	NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_CONFIG,
3375  	NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS,
3376  
3377  	NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_BACKGROUND,
3378  
3379  	NL80211_ATTR_AP_SETTINGS_FLAGS,
3380  
3381  	NL80211_ATTR_EHT_CAPABILITY,
3382  
3383  	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_EHT,
3384  
3385  	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS,
3386  	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID,
3387  	NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR,
3388  
3389  	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT,
3390  
3391  	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES,
3392  
3393  	NL80211_ATTR_EML_CAPABILITY,
3394  	NL80211_ATTR_MLD_CAPA_AND_OPS,
3395  
3396  	NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP,
3397  	NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP,
3398  	NL80211_ATTR_TD_BITMAP,
3399  
3400  	NL80211_ATTR_PUNCT_BITMAP,
3401  
3402  	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_HW_TIMESTAMP_PEERS,
3403  	NL80211_ATTR_HW_TIMESTAMP_ENABLED,
3404  
3405  	NL80211_ATTR_EMA_RNR_ELEMS,
3406  
3407  	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_DISABLED,
3408  
3409  	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_DUMP_INCLUDE_USE_DATA,
3410  
3411  	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_TTLM_DLINK,
3412  	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_TTLM_ULINK,
3413  
3414  	NL80211_ATTR_ASSOC_SPP_AMSDU,
3415  
3416  	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RADIOS,
3417  	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS,
3418  
3419  	/* add attributes here, update the policy in nl80211.c */
3420  
3421  	__NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3422  	NUM_NL80211_ATTR = __NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3423  	NL80211_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
3424  };
3425  
3426  /* source-level API compatibility */
3427  #define NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_GENERATION NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION
3428  #define	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG
3429  #define NL80211_ATTR_IFACE_SOCKET_OWNER NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER
3430  #define NL80211_ATTR_SAE_DATA NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA
3431  #define NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFF_BEACON NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_BEACON
3432  #define NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFF_PRESP NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_PRESP
3433  
3434  /*
3435   * Allow user space programs to use #ifdef on new attributes by defining them
3436   * here
3437   */
3438  #define NL80211_CMD_CONNECT NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
3439  #define NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY
3440  #define NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES
3441  #define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS
3442  #define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
3443  #define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE
3444  #define NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE
3445  #define NL80211_ATTR_IE NL80211_ATTR_IE
3446  #define NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR
3447  #define NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE
3448  #define NL80211_ATTR_FRAME NL80211_ATTR_FRAME
3449  #define NL80211_ATTR_SSID NL80211_ATTR_SSID
3450  #define NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE
3451  #define NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE
3452  #define NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE
3453  #define NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP
3454  #define NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS
3455  #define NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES
3456  #define NL80211_ATTR_KEY NL80211_ATTR_KEY
3457  #define NL80211_ATTR_KEYS NL80211_ATTR_KEYS
3458  #define NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS
3459  
3460  #define NL80211_WIPHY_NAME_MAXLEN		64
3461  
3462  #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES			32
3463  #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_HT_RATES		77
3464  #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_REG_RULES		128
3465  #define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_ENCR_KEY	0
3466  #define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_TX_MIC_KEY	16
3467  #define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_RX_MIC_KEY	24
3468  #define NL80211_HT_CAPABILITY_LEN		26
3469  #define NL80211_VHT_CAPABILITY_LEN		12
3470  #define NL80211_HE_MIN_CAPABILITY_LEN           16
3471  #define NL80211_HE_MAX_CAPABILITY_LEN           54
3472  #define NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES		5
3473  
3474  /*
3475   * NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES is obsolete when %NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES
3476   * present in %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY response.
3477   */
3478  #define NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES		2
3479  #define NL80211_EHT_MIN_CAPABILITY_LEN          13
3480  #define NL80211_EHT_MAX_CAPABILITY_LEN          51
3481  
3482  #define NL80211_MIN_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_TIME	10
3483  
3484  /* default RSSI threshold for scan results if none specified. */
3485  #define NL80211_SCAN_RSSI_THOLD_OFF		-300
3486  
3487  #define NL80211_CQM_TXE_MAX_INTVL		1800
3488  
3489  /**
3490   * enum nl80211_iftype - (virtual) interface types
3491   *
3492   * @NL80211_IFTYPE_UNSPECIFIED: unspecified type, driver decides
3493   * @NL80211_IFTYPE_ADHOC: independent BSS member
3494   * @NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION: managed BSS member
3495   * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AP: access point
3496   * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN: VLAN interface for access points; VLAN interfaces
3497   *	are a bit special in that they must always be tied to a pre-existing
3498   *	AP type interface.
3499   * @NL80211_IFTYPE_WDS: wireless distribution interface
3500   * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MONITOR: monitor interface receiving all frames
3501   * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT: mesh point
3502   * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT: P2P client
3503   * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO: P2P group owner
3504   * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_DEVICE: P2P device interface type, this is not a netdev
3505   *	and therefore can't be created in the normal ways, use the
3506   *	%NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE and %NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE
3507   *	commands to create and destroy one
3508   * @NL80211_IFTYPE_OCB: Outside Context of a BSS
3509   *	This mode corresponds to the MIB variable dot11OCBActivated=true
3510   * @NL80211_IFTYPE_NAN: NAN device interface type (not a netdev)
3511   * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX: highest interface type number currently defined
3512   * @NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES: number of defined interface types
3513   *
3514   * These values are used with the %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE
3515   * to set the type of an interface.
3516   *
3517   */
3518  enum nl80211_iftype {
3519  	NL80211_IFTYPE_UNSPECIFIED,
3520  	NL80211_IFTYPE_ADHOC,
3521  	NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION,
3522  	NL80211_IFTYPE_AP,
3523  	NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN,
3524  	NL80211_IFTYPE_WDS,
3525  	NL80211_IFTYPE_MONITOR,
3526  	NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT,
3527  	NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT,
3528  	NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO,
3529  	NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_DEVICE,
3530  	NL80211_IFTYPE_OCB,
3531  	NL80211_IFTYPE_NAN,
3532  
3533  	/* keep last */
3534  	NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES,
3535  	NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES - 1
3536  };
3537  
3538  /**
3539   * enum nl80211_sta_flags - station flags
3540   *
3541   * Station flags. When a station is added to an AP interface, it is
3542   * assumed to be already associated (and hence authenticated.)
3543   *
3544   * @__NL80211_STA_FLAG_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3545   * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
3546   * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_SHORT_PREAMBLE: station is capable of receiving frames
3547   *	with short barker preamble
3548   * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME: station is WME/QoS capable
3549   * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_MFP: station uses management frame protection
3550   * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHENTICATED: station is authenticated
3551   * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER: station is a TDLS peer -- this flag should
3552   *	only be used in managed mode (even in the flags mask). Note that the
3553   *	flag can't be changed, it is only valid while adding a station, and
3554   *	attempts to change it will silently be ignored (rather than rejected
3555   *	as errors.)
3556   * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_ASSOCIATED: station is associated; used with drivers
3557   *	that support %NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE to transition a
3558   *	previously added station into associated state
3559   * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU: station supports SPP A-MSDUs
3560   * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX: highest station flag number currently defined
3561   * @__NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3562   */
3563  enum nl80211_sta_flags {
3564  	__NL80211_STA_FLAG_INVALID,
3565  	NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED,
3566  	NL80211_STA_FLAG_SHORT_PREAMBLE,
3567  	NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME,
3568  	NL80211_STA_FLAG_MFP,
3569  	NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHENTICATED,
3570  	NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER,
3571  	NL80211_STA_FLAG_ASSOCIATED,
3572  	NL80211_STA_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU,
3573  
3574  	/* keep last */
3575  	__NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST,
3576  	NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX = __NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST - 1
3577  };
3578  
3579  /**
3580   * enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status - station support of P2P PS
3581   *
3582   * @NL80211_P2P_PS_UNSUPPORTED: station doesn't support P2P PS mechanism
3583   * @NL80211_P2P_PS_SUPPORTED: station supports P2P PS mechanism
3584   * @NUM_NL80211_P2P_PS_STATUS: number of values
3585   */
3586  enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status {
3587  	NL80211_P2P_PS_UNSUPPORTED = 0,
3588  	NL80211_P2P_PS_SUPPORTED,
3589  
3590  	NUM_NL80211_P2P_PS_STATUS,
3591  };
3592  
3593  #define NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX_OLD_API	NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER
3594  
3595  /**
3596   * struct nl80211_sta_flag_update - station flags mask/set
3597   * @mask: mask of station flags to set
3598   * @set: which values to set them to
3599   *
3600   * Both mask and set contain bits as per &enum nl80211_sta_flags.
3601   */
3602  struct nl80211_sta_flag_update {
3603  	__u32 mask;
3604  	__u32 set;
3605  } __attribute__((packed));
3606  
3607  /**
3608   * enum nl80211_he_gi - HE guard interval
3609   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_0_8: 0.8 usec
3610   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_1_6: 1.6 usec
3611   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_3_2: 3.2 usec
3612   */
3613  enum nl80211_he_gi {
3614  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_0_8,
3615  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_1_6,
3616  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_3_2,
3617  };
3618  
3619  /**
3620   * enum nl80211_he_ltf - HE long training field
3621   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_1XLTF: 3.2 usec
3622   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_2XLTF: 6.4 usec
3623   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_4XLTF: 12.8 usec
3624   */
3625  enum nl80211_he_ltf {
3626  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_1XLTF,
3627  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_2XLTF,
3628  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_4XLTF,
3629  };
3630  
3631  /**
3632   * enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc - HE RU allocation values
3633   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_26: 26-tone RU allocation
3634   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_52: 52-tone RU allocation
3635   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_106: 106-tone RU allocation
3636   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_242: 242-tone RU allocation
3637   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_484: 484-tone RU allocation
3638   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_996: 996-tone RU allocation
3639   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_2x996: 2x996-tone RU allocation
3640   */
3641  enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc {
3642  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_26,
3643  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_52,
3644  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_106,
3645  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_242,
3646  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_484,
3647  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_996,
3648  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_2x996,
3649  };
3650  
3651  /**
3652   * enum nl80211_eht_gi - EHT guard interval
3653   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_0_8: 0.8 usec
3654   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_1_6: 1.6 usec
3655   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_3_2: 3.2 usec
3656   */
3657  enum nl80211_eht_gi {
3658  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_0_8,
3659  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_1_6,
3660  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_3_2,
3661  };
3662  
3663  /**
3664   * enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc - EHT RU allocation values
3665   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_26: 26-tone RU allocation
3666   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52: 52-tone RU allocation
3667   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52P26: 52+26-tone RU allocation
3668   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106: 106-tone RU allocation
3669   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106P26: 106+26 tone RU allocation
3670   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_242: 242-tone RU allocation
3671   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484: 484-tone RU allocation
3672   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484P242: 484+242 tone RU allocation
3673   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996: 996-tone RU allocation
3674   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484: 996+484 tone RU allocation
3675   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484P242: 996+484+242 tone RU allocation
3676   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996: 2x996-tone RU allocation
3677   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996P484: 2x996+484 tone RU allocation
3678   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996: 3x996-tone RU allocation
3679   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996P484: 3x996+484 tone RU allocation
3680   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_4x996: 4x996-tone RU allocation
3681   */
3682  enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc {
3683  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_26,
3684  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52,
3685  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52P26,
3686  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106,
3687  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106P26,
3688  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_242,
3689  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484,
3690  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484P242,
3691  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996,
3692  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484,
3693  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484P242,
3694  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996,
3695  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996P484,
3696  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996,
3697  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996P484,
3698  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_4x996,
3699  };
3700  
3701  /**
3702   * enum nl80211_rate_info - bitrate information
3703   *
3704   * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_STA_INFO_TXRATE
3705   * when getting information about the bitrate of a station.
3706   * There are 2 attributes for bitrate, a legacy one that represents
3707   * a 16-bit value, and new one that represents a 32-bit value.
3708   * If the rate value fits into 16 bit, both attributes are reported
3709   * with the same value. If the rate is too high to fit into 16 bits
3710   * (>6.5535Gbps) only 32-bit attribute is included.
3711   * User space tools encouraged to use the 32-bit attribute and fall
3712   * back to the 16-bit one for compatibility with older kernels.
3713   *
3714   * @__NL80211_RATE_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3715   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE: total bitrate (u16, 100kbit/s)
3716   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_MCS: mcs index for 802.11n (u8)
3717   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_40_MHZ_WIDTH: 40 MHz dualchannel bitrate
3718   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval
3719   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE32: total bitrate (u32, 100kbit/s)
3720   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_MAX: highest rate_info number currently defined
3721   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_MCS: MCS index for VHT (u8)
3722   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_NSS: number of streams in VHT (u8)
3723   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_80_MHZ_WIDTH: 80 MHz VHT rate
3724   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_80P80_MHZ_WIDTH: unused - 80+80 is treated the
3725   *	same as 160 for purposes of the bitrates
3726   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_160_MHZ_WIDTH: 160 MHz VHT rate
3727   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_10_MHZ_WIDTH: 10 MHz width - note that this is
3728   *	a legacy rate and will be reported as the actual bitrate, i.e.
3729   *	half the base (20 MHz) rate
3730   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_5_MHZ_WIDTH: 5 MHz width - note that this is
3731   *	a legacy rate and will be reported as the actual bitrate, i.e.
3732   *	a quarter of the base (20 MHz) rate
3733   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_MCS: HE MCS index (u8, 0-11)
3734   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_NSS: HE NSS value (u8, 1-8)
3735   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI: HE guard interval identifier
3736   *	(u8, see &enum nl80211_he_gi)
3737   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_DCM: HE DCM value (u8, 0/1)
3738   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC: HE RU allocation, if not present then
3739   *	non-OFDMA was used (u8, see &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc)
3740   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_320_MHZ_WIDTH: 320 MHz bitrate
3741   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_MCS: EHT MCS index (u8, 0-15)
3742   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_NSS: EHT NSS value (u8, 1-8)
3743   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI: EHT guard interval identifier
3744   *	(u8, see &enum nl80211_eht_gi)
3745   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC: EHT RU allocation, if not present then
3746   *	non-OFDMA was used (u8, see &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc)
3747   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_S1G_MCS: S1G MCS index (u8, 0-10)
3748   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_S1G_NSS: S1G NSS value (u8, 1-4)
3749   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_1_MHZ_WIDTH: 1 MHz S1G rate
3750   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_2_MHZ_WIDTH: 2 MHz S1G rate
3751   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_4_MHZ_WIDTH: 4 MHz S1G rate
3752   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_8_MHZ_WIDTH: 8 MHz S1G rate
3753   * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_16_MHZ_WIDTH: 16 MHz S1G rate
3754   * @__NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3755   */
3756  enum nl80211_rate_info {
3757  	__NL80211_RATE_INFO_INVALID,
3758  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE,
3759  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_MCS,
3760  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_40_MHZ_WIDTH,
3761  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_SHORT_GI,
3762  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE32,
3763  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_MCS,
3764  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_NSS,
3765  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_80_MHZ_WIDTH,
3766  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_80P80_MHZ_WIDTH,
3767  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_160_MHZ_WIDTH,
3768  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_10_MHZ_WIDTH,
3769  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_5_MHZ_WIDTH,
3770  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_MCS,
3771  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_NSS,
3772  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI,
3773  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_DCM,
3774  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC,
3775  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_320_MHZ_WIDTH,
3776  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_MCS,
3777  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_NSS,
3778  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI,
3779  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC,
3780  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_S1G_MCS,
3781  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_S1G_NSS,
3782  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_1_MHZ_WIDTH,
3783  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_2_MHZ_WIDTH,
3784  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_4_MHZ_WIDTH,
3785  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_8_MHZ_WIDTH,
3786  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_16_MHZ_WIDTH,
3787  
3788  	/* keep last */
3789  	__NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
3790  	NL80211_RATE_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
3791  };
3792  
3793  /**
3794   * enum nl80211_sta_bss_param - BSS information collected by STA
3795   *
3796   * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM
3797   * when getting information about the bitrate of a station.
3798   *
3799   * @__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3800   * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled (flag)
3801   * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_PREAMBLE:  whether short preamble is enabled
3802   *	(flag)
3803   * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_SLOT_TIME:  whether short slot time is enabled
3804   *	(flag)
3805   * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_DTIM_PERIOD: DTIM period for beaconing (u8)
3806   * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_BEACON_INTERVAL: Beacon interval (u16)
3807   * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_MAX: highest sta_bss_param number currently defined
3808   * @__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3809   */
3810  enum nl80211_sta_bss_param {
3811  	__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_INVALID,
3812  	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_CTS_PROT,
3813  	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_PREAMBLE,
3814  	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_SLOT_TIME,
3815  	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_DTIM_PERIOD,
3816  	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_BEACON_INTERVAL,
3817  
3818  	/* keep last */
3819  	__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST,
3820  	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_MAX = __NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST - 1
3821  };
3822  
3823  /**
3824   * enum nl80211_sta_info - station information
3825   *
3826   * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO
3827   * when getting information about a station.
3828   *
3829   * @__NL80211_STA_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3830   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_INACTIVE_TIME: time since last activity (u32, msecs)
3831   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES: total received bytes (MPDU length)
3832   *	(u32, from this station)
3833   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES: total transmitted bytes (MPDU length)
3834   *	(u32, to this station)
3835   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES64: total received bytes (MPDU length)
3836   *	(u64, from this station)
3837   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES64: total transmitted bytes (MPDU length)
3838   *	(u64, to this station)
3839   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL: signal strength of last received PPDU (u8, dBm)
3840   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE: current unicast tx rate, nested attribute
3841   *	containing info as possible, see &enum nl80211_rate_info
3842   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_PACKETS: total received packet (MSDUs and MMPDUs)
3843   *	(u32, from this station)
3844   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_PACKETS: total transmitted packets (MSDUs and MMPDUs)
3845   *	(u32, to this station)
3846   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_RETRIES: total retries (MPDUs) (u32, to this station)
3847   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_FAILED: total failed packets (MPDUs)
3848   *	(u32, to this station)
3849   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL_AVG: signal strength average (u8, dBm)
3850   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_LLID: the station's mesh LLID
3851   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PLID: the station's mesh PLID
3852   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PLINK_STATE: peer link state for the station
3853   *	(see %enum nl80211_plink_state)
3854   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BITRATE: last unicast data frame rx rate, nested
3855   *	attribute, like NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE.
3856   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM: current station's view of BSS, nested attribute
3857   *     containing info as possible, see &enum nl80211_sta_bss_param
3858   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TIME: time since the station is last connected
3859   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_STA_FLAGS: Contains a struct nl80211_sta_flag_update.
3860   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_LOSS: count of times beacon loss was detected (u32)
3861   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_T_OFFSET: timing offset with respect to this STA (s64)
3862   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_LOCAL_PM: local mesh STA link-specific power mode
3863   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PEER_PM: peer mesh STA link-specific power mode
3864   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_NONPEER_PM: neighbor mesh STA power save mode towards
3865   *	non-peer STA
3866   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL: per-chain signal strength of last PPDU
3867   *	Contains a nested array of signal strength attributes (u8, dBm)
3868   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL_AVG: per-chain signal strength average
3869   *	Same format as NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL.
3870   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_EXPECTED_THROUGHPUT: expected throughput considering also
3871   *	the 802.11 header (u32, kbps)
3872   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DROP_MISC: RX packets dropped for unspecified reasons
3873   *	(u64)
3874   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_RX: number of beacons received from this peer (u64)
3875   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_SIGNAL_AVG: signal strength average
3876   *	for beacons only (u8, dBm)
3877   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TID_STATS: per-TID statistics (see &enum nl80211_tid_stats)
3878   *	This is a nested attribute where each the inner attribute number is the
3879   *	TID+1 and the special TID 16 (i.e. value 17) is used for non-QoS frames;
3880   *	each one of those is again nested with &enum nl80211_tid_stats
3881   *	attributes carrying the actual values.
3882   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DURATION: aggregate PPDU duration for all frames
3883   *	received from the station (u64, usec)
3884   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
3885   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL: signal strength of the last ACK frame(u8, dBm)
3886   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG: avg signal strength of ACK frames (s8, dBm)
3887   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_MPDUS: total number of received packets (MPDUs)
3888   *	(u32, from this station)
3889   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_FCS_ERROR_COUNT: total number of packets (MPDUs) received
3890   *	with an FCS error (u32, from this station). This count may not include
3891   *	some packets with an FCS error due to TA corruption. Hence this counter
3892   *	might not be fully accurate.
3893   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_GATE: set to true if STA has a path to a
3894   *	mesh gate (u8, 0 or 1)
3895   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_DURATION: aggregate PPDU duration for all frames
3896   *	sent to the station (u64, usec)
3897   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_WEIGHT: current airtime weight for station (u16)
3898   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_LINK_METRIC: airtime link metric for mesh station
3899   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ASSOC_AT_BOOTTIME: Timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME, nanoseconds)
3900   *	of STA's association
3901   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_AS: set to true if STA has a path to a
3902   *	authentication server (u8, 0 or 1)
3903   * @__NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal
3904   * @NL80211_STA_INFO_MAX: highest possible station info attribute
3905   */
3906  enum nl80211_sta_info {
3907  	__NL80211_STA_INFO_INVALID,
3908  	NL80211_STA_INFO_INACTIVE_TIME,
3909  	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES,
3910  	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES,
3911  	NL80211_STA_INFO_LLID,
3912  	NL80211_STA_INFO_PLID,
3913  	NL80211_STA_INFO_PLINK_STATE,
3914  	NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL,
3915  	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE,
3916  	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_PACKETS,
3917  	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_PACKETS,
3918  	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_RETRIES,
3919  	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_FAILED,
3920  	NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL_AVG,
3921  	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BITRATE,
3922  	NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM,
3923  	NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TIME,
3924  	NL80211_STA_INFO_STA_FLAGS,
3925  	NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_LOSS,
3926  	NL80211_STA_INFO_T_OFFSET,
3927  	NL80211_STA_INFO_LOCAL_PM,
3928  	NL80211_STA_INFO_PEER_PM,
3929  	NL80211_STA_INFO_NONPEER_PM,
3930  	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES64,
3931  	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES64,
3932  	NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL,
3933  	NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL_AVG,
3934  	NL80211_STA_INFO_EXPECTED_THROUGHPUT,
3935  	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DROP_MISC,
3936  	NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_RX,
3937  	NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_SIGNAL_AVG,
3938  	NL80211_STA_INFO_TID_STATS,
3939  	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DURATION,
3940  	NL80211_STA_INFO_PAD,
3941  	NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL,
3942  	NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG,
3943  	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_MPDUS,
3944  	NL80211_STA_INFO_FCS_ERROR_COUNT,
3945  	NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_GATE,
3946  	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_DURATION,
3947  	NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_WEIGHT,
3948  	NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_LINK_METRIC,
3949  	NL80211_STA_INFO_ASSOC_AT_BOOTTIME,
3950  	NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_AS,
3951  
3952  	/* keep last */
3953  	__NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
3954  	NL80211_STA_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
3955  };
3956  
3957  /* we renamed this - stay compatible */
3958  #define NL80211_STA_INFO_DATA_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG
3959  
3960  
3961  /**
3962   * enum nl80211_tid_stats - per TID statistics attributes
3963   * @__NL80211_TID_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3964   * @NL80211_TID_STATS_RX_MSDU: number of MSDUs received (u64)
3965   * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU: number of MSDUs transmitted (or
3966   *	attempted to transmit; u64)
3967   * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_RETRIES: number of retries for
3968   *	transmitted MSDUs (not counting the first attempt; u64)
3969   * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_FAILED: number of failed transmitted
3970   *	MSDUs (u64)
3971   * @NL80211_TID_STATS_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
3972   * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TXQ_STATS: TXQ stats (nested attribute)
3973   * @NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS: number of attributes here
3974   * @NL80211_TID_STATS_MAX: highest numbered attribute here
3975   */
3976  enum nl80211_tid_stats {
3977  	__NL80211_TID_STATS_INVALID,
3978  	NL80211_TID_STATS_RX_MSDU,
3979  	NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU,
3980  	NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_RETRIES,
3981  	NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_FAILED,
3982  	NL80211_TID_STATS_PAD,
3983  	NL80211_TID_STATS_TXQ_STATS,
3984  
3985  	/* keep last */
3986  	NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS,
3987  	NL80211_TID_STATS_MAX = NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS - 1
3988  };
3989  
3990  /**
3991   * enum nl80211_txq_stats - per TXQ statistics attributes
3992   * @__NL80211_TXQ_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3993   * @NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS: number of attributes here
3994   * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_BYTES: number of bytes currently backlogged
3995   * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_PACKETS: number of packets currently
3996   *      backlogged
3997   * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_FLOWS: total number of new flows seen
3998   * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_DROPS: total number of packet drops
3999   * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_ECN_MARKS: total number of packet ECN marks
4000   * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERLIMIT: number of drops due to queue space overflow
4001   * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERMEMORY: number of drops due to memory limit overflow
4002   *      (only for per-phy stats)
4003   * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_COLLISIONS: number of hash collisions
4004   * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_BYTES: total number of bytes dequeued from TXQ
4005   * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_PACKETS: total number of packets dequeued from TXQ
4006   * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX_FLOWS: number of flow buckets for PHY
4007   * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX: highest numbered attribute here
4008   */
4009  enum nl80211_txq_stats {
4010  	__NL80211_TXQ_STATS_INVALID,
4011  	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_BYTES,
4012  	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_PACKETS,
4013  	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_FLOWS,
4014  	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_DROPS,
4015  	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_ECN_MARKS,
4016  	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERLIMIT,
4017  	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERMEMORY,
4018  	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_COLLISIONS,
4019  	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_BYTES,
4020  	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_PACKETS,
4021  	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX_FLOWS,
4022  
4023  	/* keep last */
4024  	NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS,
4025  	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX = NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS - 1
4026  };
4027  
4028  /**
4029   * enum nl80211_mpath_flags - nl80211 mesh path flags
4030   *
4031   * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_ACTIVE: the mesh path is active
4032   * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVING: the mesh path discovery process is running
4033   * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_SN_VALID: the mesh path contains a valid SN
4034   * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_FIXED: the mesh path has been manually set
4035   * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVED: the mesh path discovery process succeeded
4036   */
4037  enum nl80211_mpath_flags {
4038  	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_ACTIVE =	1<<0,
4039  	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVING =	1<<1,
4040  	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_SN_VALID =	1<<2,
4041  	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_FIXED =	1<<3,
4042  	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVED =	1<<4,
4043  };
4044  
4045  /**
4046   * enum nl80211_mpath_info - mesh path information
4047   *
4048   * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO when getting
4049   * information about a mesh path.
4050   *
4051   * @__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4052   * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: number of queued frames for this destination
4053   * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_SN: destination sequence number
4054   * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_METRIC: metric (cost) of this mesh path
4055   * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: expiration time for the path, in msec from now
4056   * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: mesh path flags, enumerated in
4057   *	&enum nl80211_mpath_flags;
4058   * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: total path discovery timeout, in msec
4059   * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: mesh path discovery retries
4060   * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: hop count to destination
4061   * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: total number of path changes to destination
4062   * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_MAX: highest mesh path information attribute number
4063   *	currently defined
4064   * @__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4065   */
4066  enum nl80211_mpath_info {
4067  	__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_INVALID,
4068  	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN,
4069  	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_SN,
4070  	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_METRIC,
4071  	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME,
4072  	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FLAGS,
4073  	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT,
4074  	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES,
4075  	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT,
4076  	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE,
4077  
4078  	/* keep last */
4079  	__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
4080  	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
4081  };
4082  
4083  /**
4084   * enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr - Interface type data attributes
4085   *
4086   * @__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4087   * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing a flag attribute
4088   *     for each interface type that supports the band data
4089   * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MAC: HE MAC capabilities as in HE
4090   *     capabilities IE
4091   * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PHY: HE PHY capabilities as in HE
4092   *     capabilities IE
4093   * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MCS_SET: HE supported NSS/MCS as in HE
4094   *     capabilities IE
4095   * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PPE: HE PPE thresholds information as
4096   *     defined in HE capabilities IE
4097   * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPA: HE 6GHz band capabilities (__le16),
4098   *	given for all 6 GHz band channels
4099   * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_VENDOR_ELEMS: vendor element capabilities that are
4100   *	advertised on this band/for this iftype (binary)
4101   * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MAC: EHT MAC capabilities as in EHT
4102   *	capabilities element
4103   * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PHY: EHT PHY capabilities as in EHT
4104   *	capabilities element
4105   * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MCS_SET: EHT supported NSS/MCS as in EHT
4106   *	capabilities element
4107   * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PPE: EHT PPE thresholds information as
4108   *	defined in EHT capabilities element
4109   * @__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4110   * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_MAX: highest band attribute currently defined
4111   */
4112  enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr {
4113  	__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_INVALID,
4114  
4115  	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_IFTYPES,
4116  	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MAC,
4117  	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PHY,
4118  	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MCS_SET,
4119  	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PPE,
4120  	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPA,
4121  	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_VENDOR_ELEMS,
4122  	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MAC,
4123  	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PHY,
4124  	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MCS_SET,
4125  	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PPE,
4126  
4127  	/* keep last */
4128  	__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4129  	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4130  };
4131  
4132  /**
4133   * enum nl80211_band_attr - band attributes
4134   * @__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4135   * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_FREQS: supported frequencies in this band,
4136   *	an array of nested frequency attributes
4137   * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_RATES: supported bitrates in this band,
4138   *	an array of nested bitrate attributes
4139   * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_MCS_SET: 16-byte attribute containing the MCS set as
4140   *	defined in 802.11n
4141   * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA: HT capabilities, as in the HT information IE
4142   * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_FACTOR: A-MPDU factor, as in 11n
4143   * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_DENSITY: A-MPDU density, as in 11n
4144   * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_MCS_SET: 32-byte attribute containing the MCS set as
4145   *	defined in 802.11ac
4146   * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_CAPA: VHT capabilities, as in the HT information IE
4147   * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_IFTYPE_DATA: nested array attribute, with each entry using
4148   *	attributes from &enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr
4149   * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_CHANNELS: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz
4150   *	channel(s) that are allowed to be used for EDMG transmissions.
4151   *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251.
4152   * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_BW_CONFIG: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes
4153   *	the allowed channel bandwidth configurations.
4154   *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251, Table 13.
4155   * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_S1G_MCS_NSS_SET: S1G capabilities, supported S1G-MCS and NSS
4156   *	set subfield, as in the S1G information IE, 5 bytes
4157   * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_S1G_CAPA: S1G capabilities information subfield as in the
4158   *	S1G information IE, 10 bytes
4159   * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_MAX: highest band attribute currently defined
4160   * @__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4161   */
4162  enum nl80211_band_attr {
4163  	__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_INVALID,
4164  	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_FREQS,
4165  	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_RATES,
4166  
4167  	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_MCS_SET,
4168  	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA,
4169  	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_FACTOR,
4170  	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_DENSITY,
4171  
4172  	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_MCS_SET,
4173  	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_CAPA,
4174  	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_IFTYPE_DATA,
4175  
4176  	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_CHANNELS,
4177  	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_BW_CONFIG,
4178  
4179  	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_S1G_MCS_NSS_SET,
4180  	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_S1G_CAPA,
4181  
4182  	/* keep last */
4183  	__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4184  	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4185  };
4186  
4187  #define NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA
4188  
4189  /**
4190   * enum nl80211_wmm_rule - regulatory wmm rule
4191   *
4192   * @__NL80211_WMMR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4193   * @NL80211_WMMR_CW_MIN: Minimum contention window slot.
4194   * @NL80211_WMMR_CW_MAX: Maximum contention window slot.
4195   * @NL80211_WMMR_AIFSN: Arbitration Inter Frame Space.
4196   * @NL80211_WMMR_TXOP: Maximum allowed tx operation time.
4197   * @NL80211_WMMR_MAX: highest possible wmm rule.
4198   * @__NL80211_WMMR_LAST: Internal use.
4199   */
4200  enum nl80211_wmm_rule {
4201  	__NL80211_WMMR_INVALID,
4202  	NL80211_WMMR_CW_MIN,
4203  	NL80211_WMMR_CW_MAX,
4204  	NL80211_WMMR_AIFSN,
4205  	NL80211_WMMR_TXOP,
4206  
4207  	/* keep last */
4208  	__NL80211_WMMR_LAST,
4209  	NL80211_WMMR_MAX = __NL80211_WMMR_LAST - 1
4210  };
4211  
4212  /**
4213   * enum nl80211_frequency_attr - frequency attributes
4214   * @__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4215   * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_FREQ: Frequency in MHz
4216   * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DISABLED: Channel is disabled in current
4217   *	regulatory domain.
4218   * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR: no mechanisms that initiate radiation
4219   *	are permitted on this channel, this includes sending probe
4220   *	requests, or modes of operation that require beaconing.
4221   * @__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IBSS: obsolete, same as _NO_IR
4222   * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_RADAR: Radar detection is mandatory
4223   *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4224   * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER: Maximum transmission power in mBm
4225   *	(100 * dBm).
4226   * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_STATE: current state for DFS
4227   *	(enum nl80211_dfs_state)
4228   * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_TIME: time in milliseconds for how long
4229   *	this channel is in this DFS state.
4230   * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_MINUS: HT40- isn't possible with this
4231   *	channel as the control channel
4232   * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_PLUS: HT40+ isn't possible with this
4233   *	channel as the control channel
4234   * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_80MHZ: any 80 MHz channel using this channel
4235   *	as the primary or any of the secondary channels isn't possible,
4236   *	this includes 80+80 channels
4237   * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_160MHZ: any 160 MHz (but not 80+80) channel
4238   *	using this channel as the primary or any of the secondary channels
4239   *	isn't possible
4240   * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME: DFS CAC time in milliseconds.
4241   * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY: Only indoor use is permitted on this
4242   *	channel. A channel that has the INDOOR_ONLY attribute can only be
4243   *	used when there is a clear assessment that the device is operating in
4244   *	an indoor surroundings, i.e., it is connected to AC power (and not
4245   *	through portable DC inverters) or is under the control of a master
4246   *	that is acting as an AP and is connected to AC power.
4247   * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT: IR operation is allowed on this
4248   *	channel if it's connected concurrently to a BSS on the same channel on
4249   *	the 2 GHz band or to a channel in the same UNII band (on the 5 GHz
4250   *	band), and IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR is not set. Instantiating a GO or TDLS
4251   *	off-channel on a channel that has the IR_CONCURRENT attribute set can be
4252   *	done when there is a clear assessment that the device is operating under
4253   *	the guidance of an authorized master, i.e., setting up a GO or TDLS
4254   *	off-channel while the device is also connected to an AP with DFS and
4255   *	radar detection on the UNII band (it is up to user-space, i.e.,
4256   *	wpa_supplicant to perform the required verifications). Using this
4257   *	attribute for IR is disallowed for master interfaces (IBSS, AP).
4258   * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz operation is not allowed
4259   *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4260   * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz operation is not allowed
4261   *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4262   * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_WMM: this channel has wmm limitations.
4263   *	This is a nested attribute that contains the wmm limitation per AC.
4264   *	(see &enum nl80211_wmm_rule)
4265   * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HE: HE operation is not allowed on this channel
4266   *	in current regulatory domain.
4267   * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_OFFSET: frequency offset in KHz
4268   * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_1MHZ: 1 MHz operation is allowed
4269   *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4270   * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_2MHZ: 2 MHz operation is allowed
4271   *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4272   * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_4MHZ: 4 MHz operation is allowed
4273   *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4274   * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_8MHZ: 8 MHz operation is allowed
4275   *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4276   * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_16MHZ: 16 MHz operation is allowed
4277   *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4278   * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_320MHZ: any 320 MHz channel using this channel
4279   *	as the primary or any of the secondary channels isn't possible
4280   * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_EHT: EHT operation is not allowed on this channel
4281   *	in current regulatory domain.
4282   * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_PSD: Power spectral density (in dBm) that
4283   *	is allowed on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4284   * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CONCURRENT: Operation on this channel is
4285   *	allowed for peer-to-peer or adhoc communication under the control
4286   *	of a DFS master which operates on the same channel (FCC-594280 D01
4287   *	Section B.3). Should be used together with %NL80211_RRF_DFS only.
4288   * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT: Client connection to VLP AP
4289   *	not allowed using this channel
4290   * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT: Client connection to AFC AP
4291   *	not allowed using this channel
4292   * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_CAN_MONITOR: This channel can be used in monitor
4293   *	mode despite other (regulatory) restrictions, even if the channel is
4294   *	otherwise completely disabled.
4295   * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_ALLOW_6GHZ_VLP_AP: This channel can be used for a
4296   *	very low power (VLP) AP, despite being NO_IR.
4297   * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX: highest frequency attribute number
4298   *	currently defined
4299   * @__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4300   *
4301   * See https://apps.fcc.gov/eas/comments/GetPublishedDocument.html?id=327&tn=528122
4302   * for more information on the FCC description of the relaxations allowed
4303   * by NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY and
4304   * NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT.
4305   */
4306  enum nl80211_frequency_attr {
4307  	__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INVALID,
4308  	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_FREQ,
4309  	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DISABLED,
4310  	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR,
4311  	__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IBSS,
4312  	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_RADAR,
4313  	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER,
4314  	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_STATE,
4315  	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_TIME,
4316  	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_MINUS,
4317  	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_PLUS,
4318  	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_80MHZ,
4319  	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_160MHZ,
4320  	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME,
4321  	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY,
4322  	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT,
4323  	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_20MHZ,
4324  	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_10MHZ,
4325  	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_WMM,
4326  	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HE,
4327  	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_OFFSET,
4328  	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_1MHZ,
4329  	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_2MHZ,
4330  	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_4MHZ,
4331  	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_8MHZ,
4332  	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_16MHZ,
4333  	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_320MHZ,
4334  	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_EHT,
4335  	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_PSD,
4336  	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CONCURRENT,
4337  	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT,
4338  	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT,
4339  	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_CAN_MONITOR,
4340  	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_ALLOW_6GHZ_VLP_AP,
4341  
4342  	/* keep last */
4343  	__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4344  	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4345  };
4346  
4347  #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER
4348  #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_PASSIVE_SCAN	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR
4349  #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IBSS		NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR
4350  #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR		NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR
4351  #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_GO_CONCURRENT \
4352  					NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
4353  #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_UHB_VLP_CLIENT \
4354  	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT
4355  #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_UHB_AFC_CLIENT \
4356  	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT
4357  
4358  /**
4359   * enum nl80211_bitrate_attr - bitrate attributes
4360   * @__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4361   * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_RATE: Bitrate in units of 100 kbps
4362   * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_2GHZ_SHORTPREAMBLE: Short preamble supported
4363   *	in 2.4 GHz band.
4364   * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_MAX: highest bitrate attribute number
4365   *	currently defined
4366   * @__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4367   */
4368  enum nl80211_bitrate_attr {
4369  	__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_INVALID,
4370  	NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_RATE,
4371  	NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_2GHZ_SHORTPREAMBLE,
4372  
4373  	/* keep last */
4374  	__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4375  	NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4376  };
4377  
4378  /**
4379   * enum nl80211_reg_initiator - Indicates the initiator of a reg domain request
4380   * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_CORE: Core queried CRDA for a dynamic world
4381   *	regulatory domain.
4382   * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_USER: User asked the wireless core to set the
4383   *	regulatory domain.
4384   * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER: a wireless drivers has hinted to the
4385   *	wireless core it thinks its knows the regulatory domain we should be in.
4386   * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE: the wireless core has received an
4387   *	802.11 country information element with regulatory information it
4388   *	thinks we should consider. cfg80211 only processes the country
4389   *	code from the IE, and relies on the regulatory domain information
4390   *	structure passed by userspace (CRDA) from our wireless-regdb.
4391   *	If a channel is enabled but the country code indicates it should
4392   *	be disabled we disable the channel and re-enable it upon disassociation.
4393   */
4394  enum nl80211_reg_initiator {
4395  	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_CORE,
4396  	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_USER,
4397  	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER,
4398  	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE,
4399  };
4400  
4401  /**
4402   * enum nl80211_reg_type - specifies the type of regulatory domain
4403   * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_COUNTRY: the regulatory domain set is one that pertains
4404   *	to a specific country. When this is set you can count on the
4405   *	ISO / IEC 3166 alpha2 country code being valid.
4406   * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_WORLD: the regulatory set domain is the world regulatory
4407   *	domain.
4408   * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_CUSTOM_WORLD: the regulatory domain set is a custom
4409   *	driver specific world regulatory domain. These do not apply system-wide
4410   *	and are only applicable to the individual devices which have requested
4411   *	them to be applied.
4412   * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_INTERSECTION: the regulatory domain set is the product
4413   *	of an intersection between two regulatory domains -- the previously
4414   *	set regulatory domain on the system and the last accepted regulatory
4415   *	domain request to be processed.
4416   */
4417  enum nl80211_reg_type {
4418  	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_COUNTRY,
4419  	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_WORLD,
4420  	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_CUSTOM_WORLD,
4421  	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_INTERSECTION,
4422  };
4423  
4424  /**
4425   * enum nl80211_reg_rule_attr - regulatory rule attributes
4426   * @__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4427   * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS: a set of flags which specify additional
4428   *	considerations for a given frequency range. These are the
4429   *	&enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags.
4430   * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_START: starting frequencry for the regulatory
4431   *	rule in KHz. This is not a center of frequency but an actual regulatory
4432   *	band edge.
4433   * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_END: ending frequency for the regulatory rule
4434   *	in KHz. This is not a center a frequency but an actual regulatory
4435   *	band edge.
4436   * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW: maximum allowed bandwidth for this
4437   *	frequency range, in KHz.
4438   * @NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_ANT_GAIN: the maximum allowed antenna gain
4439   *	for a given frequency range. The value is in mBi (100 * dBi).
4440   *	If you don't have one then don't send this.
4441   * @NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_EIRP: the maximum allowed EIRP for
4442   *	a given frequency range. The value is in mBm (100 * dBm).
4443   * @NL80211_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME: DFS CAC time in milliseconds.
4444   *	If not present or 0 default CAC time will be used.
4445   * @NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_PSD: power spectral density (in dBm).
4446   *	This could be negative.
4447   * @NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_MAX: highest regulatory rule attribute number
4448   *	currently defined
4449   * @__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4450   */
4451  enum nl80211_reg_rule_attr {
4452  	__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_INVALID,
4453  	NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS,
4454  
4455  	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_START,
4456  	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_END,
4457  	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW,
4458  
4459  	NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_ANT_GAIN,
4460  	NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_EIRP,
4461  
4462  	NL80211_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME,
4463  
4464  	NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_PSD,
4465  
4466  	/* keep last */
4467  	__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4468  	NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4469  };
4470  
4471  /**
4472   * enum nl80211_sched_scan_match_attr - scheduled scan match attributes
4473   * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4474   * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID: SSID to be used for matching,
4475   *	only report BSS with matching SSID.
4476   *	(This cannot be used together with BSSID.)
4477   * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI: RSSI threshold (in dBm) for reporting a
4478   *	BSS in scan results. Filtering is turned off if not specified. Note that
4479   *	if this attribute is in a match set of its own, then it is treated as
4480   *	the default value for all matchsets with an SSID, rather than being a
4481   *	matchset of its own without an RSSI filter. This is due to problems with
4482   *	how this API was implemented in the past. Also, due to the same problem,
4483   *	the only way to create a matchset with only an RSSI filter (with this
4484   *	attribute) is if there's only a single matchset with the RSSI attribute.
4485   * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RELATIVE_RSSI: Flag indicating whether
4486   *	%NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI to be used as absolute RSSI or
4487   *	relative to current bss's RSSI.
4488   * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for
4489   *	BSS-es in the specified band is to be adjusted before doing
4490   *	RSSI-based BSS selection. The attribute value is a packed structure
4491   *	value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust.
4492   * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_BSSID: BSSID to be used for matching
4493   *	(this cannot be used together with SSID).
4494   * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_PER_BAND_RSSI: Obsolete
4495   * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX: highest scheduled scan filter
4496   *	attribute number currently defined
4497   * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4498   */
4499  enum nl80211_sched_scan_match_attr {
4500  	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_INVALID,
4501  
4502  	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID,
4503  	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI,
4504  	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RELATIVE_RSSI,
4505  	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST,
4506  	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_BSSID,
4507  	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_PER_BAND_RSSI, /* obsolete */
4508  
4509  	/* keep last */
4510  	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4511  	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX =
4512  		__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4513  };
4514  
4515  /* only for backward compatibility */
4516  #define NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_SSID NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID
4517  
4518  /**
4519   * enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags - regulatory rule flags
4520   *
4521   * @NL80211_RRF_NO_OFDM: OFDM modulation not allowed
4522   * @NL80211_RRF_NO_CCK: CCK modulation not allowed
4523   * @NL80211_RRF_NO_INDOOR: indoor operation not allowed
4524   * @NL80211_RRF_NO_OUTDOOR: outdoor operation not allowed
4525   * @NL80211_RRF_DFS: DFS support is required to be used
4526   * @NL80211_RRF_PTP_ONLY: this is only for Point To Point links
4527   * @NL80211_RRF_PTMP_ONLY: this is only for Point To Multi Point links
4528   * @NL80211_RRF_NO_IR: no mechanisms that initiate radiation are allowed,
4529   *	this includes probe requests or modes of operation that require
4530   *	beaconing.
4531   * @__NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS: obsolete, same as NO_IR
4532   * @NL80211_RRF_AUTO_BW: maximum available bandwidth should be calculated
4533   *	base on contiguous rules and wider channels will be allowed to cross
4534   *	multiple contiguous/overlapping frequency ranges.
4535   * @NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT: See %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
4536   * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS: channels can't be used in HT40- operation
4537   * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS: channels can't be used in HT40+ operation
4538   * @NL80211_RRF_NO_80MHZ: 80MHz operation not allowed
4539   * @NL80211_RRF_NO_160MHZ: 160MHz operation not allowed
4540   * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HE: HE operation not allowed
4541   * @NL80211_RRF_NO_320MHZ: 320MHz operation not allowed
4542   * @NL80211_RRF_NO_EHT: EHT operation not allowed
4543   * @NL80211_RRF_PSD: Ruleset has power spectral density value
4544   * @NL80211_RRF_DFS_CONCURRENT: Operation on this channel is allowed for
4545   *	peer-to-peer or adhoc communication under the control of a DFS master
4546   *	which operates on the same channel (FCC-594280 D01 Section B.3).
4547   *	Should be used together with %NL80211_RRF_DFS only.
4548   * @NL80211_RRF_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT: Client connection to VLP AP not allowed
4549   * @NL80211_RRF_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT: Client connection to AFC AP not allowed
4550   * @NL80211_RRF_ALLOW_6GHZ_VLP_AP: Very low power (VLP) AP can be permitted
4551   *	despite NO_IR configuration.
4552   */
4553  enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags {
4554  	NL80211_RRF_NO_OFDM		= 1<<0,
4555  	NL80211_RRF_NO_CCK		= 1<<1,
4556  	NL80211_RRF_NO_INDOOR		= 1<<2,
4557  	NL80211_RRF_NO_OUTDOOR		= 1<<3,
4558  	NL80211_RRF_DFS			= 1<<4,
4559  	NL80211_RRF_PTP_ONLY		= 1<<5,
4560  	NL80211_RRF_PTMP_ONLY		= 1<<6,
4561  	NL80211_RRF_NO_IR		= 1<<7,
4562  	__NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS		= 1<<8,
4563  	NL80211_RRF_AUTO_BW		= 1<<11,
4564  	NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT	= 1<<12,
4565  	NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS	= 1<<13,
4566  	NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS		= 1<<14,
4567  	NL80211_RRF_NO_80MHZ		= 1<<15,
4568  	NL80211_RRF_NO_160MHZ		= 1<<16,
4569  	NL80211_RRF_NO_HE		= 1<<17,
4570  	NL80211_RRF_NO_320MHZ		= 1<<18,
4571  	NL80211_RRF_NO_EHT		= 1<<19,
4572  	NL80211_RRF_PSD			= 1<<20,
4573  	NL80211_RRF_DFS_CONCURRENT	= 1<<21,
4574  	NL80211_RRF_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT	= 1<<22,
4575  	NL80211_RRF_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT	= 1<<23,
4576  	NL80211_RRF_ALLOW_6GHZ_VLP_AP	= 1<<24,
4577  };
4578  
4579  #define NL80211_RRF_PASSIVE_SCAN	NL80211_RRF_NO_IR
4580  #define NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS		NL80211_RRF_NO_IR
4581  #define NL80211_RRF_NO_IR		NL80211_RRF_NO_IR
4582  #define NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40		(NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS |\
4583  					 NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS)
4584  #define NL80211_RRF_GO_CONCURRENT	NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT
4585  #define NL80211_RRF_NO_UHB_VLP_CLIENT	NL80211_RRF_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT
4586  #define NL80211_RRF_NO_UHB_AFC_CLIENT	NL80211_RRF_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT
4587  
4588  /* For backport compatibility with older userspace */
4589  #define NL80211_RRF_NO_IR_ALL		(NL80211_RRF_NO_IR | __NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS)
4590  
4591  /**
4592   * enum nl80211_dfs_regions - regulatory DFS regions
4593   *
4594   * @NL80211_DFS_UNSET: Country has no DFS master region specified
4595   * @NL80211_DFS_FCC: Country follows DFS master rules from FCC
4596   * @NL80211_DFS_ETSI: Country follows DFS master rules from ETSI
4597   * @NL80211_DFS_JP: Country follows DFS master rules from JP/MKK/Telec
4598   */
4599  enum nl80211_dfs_regions {
4600  	NL80211_DFS_UNSET	= 0,
4601  	NL80211_DFS_FCC		= 1,
4602  	NL80211_DFS_ETSI	= 2,
4603  	NL80211_DFS_JP		= 3,
4604  };
4605  
4606  /**
4607   * enum nl80211_user_reg_hint_type - type of user regulatory hint
4608   *
4609   * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_USER: a user sent the hint. This is always
4610   *	assumed if the attribute is not set.
4611   * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_CELL_BASE: the hint comes from a cellular
4612   *	base station. Device drivers that have been tested to work
4613   *	properly to support this type of hint can enable these hints
4614   *	by setting the NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS feature
4615   *	capability on the struct wiphy. The wireless core will
4616   *	ignore all cell base station hints until at least one device
4617   *	present has been registered with the wireless core that
4618   *	has listed NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS as a
4619   *	supported feature.
4620   * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_INDOOR: a user sent an hint indicating that the
4621   *	platform is operating in an indoor environment.
4622   */
4623  enum nl80211_user_reg_hint_type {
4624  	NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_USER	= 0,
4625  	NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_CELL_BASE = 1,
4626  	NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_INDOOR    = 2,
4627  };
4628  
4629  /**
4630   * enum nl80211_survey_info - survey information
4631   *
4632   * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO
4633   * when getting information about a survey.
4634   *
4635   * @__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4636   * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY: center frequency of channel
4637   * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_NOISE: noise level of channel (u8, dBm)
4638   * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used
4639   * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME: amount of time (in ms) that the radio
4640   *	was turned on (on channel or globally)
4641   * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: amount of the time the primary
4642   *	channel was sensed busy (either due to activity or energy detect)
4643   * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: amount of time the extension
4644   *	channel was sensed busy
4645   * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: amount of time the radio spent
4646   *	receiving data (on channel or globally)
4647   * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: amount of time the radio spent
4648   *	transmitting data (on channel or globally)
4649   * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: time the radio spent for scan
4650   *	(on this channel or globally)
4651   * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
4652   * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: amount of time the radio spent
4653   *	receiving frames destined to the local BSS
4654   * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_MAX: highest survey info attribute number
4655   *	currently defined
4656   * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY_OFFSET: center frequency offset in KHz
4657   * @__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4658   */
4659  enum nl80211_survey_info {
4660  	__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_INVALID,
4661  	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY,
4662  	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_NOISE,
4663  	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE,
4664  	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME,
4665  	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY,
4666  	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY,
4667  	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX,
4668  	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX,
4669  	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN,
4670  	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_PAD,
4671  	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX,
4672  	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY_OFFSET,
4673  
4674  	/* keep last */
4675  	__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
4676  	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
4677  };
4678  
4679  /* keep old names for compatibility */
4680  #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME
4681  #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_BUSY		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY
4682  #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_EXT_BUSY	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY
4683  #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_RX		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX
4684  #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_TX		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX
4685  
4686  /**
4687   * enum nl80211_mntr_flags - monitor configuration flags
4688   *
4689   * Monitor configuration flags.
4690   *
4691   * @__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID: reserved
4692   *
4693   * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS
4694   * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP
4695   * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames
4696   * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering
4697   * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: report frames after processing.
4698   *	overrides all other flags.
4699   * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE: use the configured MAC address
4700   *	and ACK incoming unicast packets.
4701   *
4702   * @__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4703   * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_MAX: highest possible monitor flag
4704   */
4705  enum nl80211_mntr_flags {
4706  	__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID,
4707  	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL,
4708  	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL,
4709  	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL,
4710  	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS,
4711  	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES,
4712  	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE,
4713  
4714  	/* keep last */
4715  	__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST,
4716  	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_MAX = __NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST - 1
4717  };
4718  
4719  /**
4720   * enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode - mesh power save modes
4721   *
4722   * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_UNKNOWN: The mesh power mode of the mesh STA is
4723   *	not known or has not been set yet.
4724   * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_ACTIVE: Active mesh power mode. The mesh STA is
4725   *	in Awake state all the time.
4726   * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_LIGHT_SLEEP: Light sleep mode. The mesh STA will
4727   *	alternate between Active and Doze states, but will wake up for
4728   *	neighbor's beacons.
4729   * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_DEEP_SLEEP: Deep sleep mode. The mesh STA will
4730   *	alternate between Active and Doze states, but may not wake up
4731   *	for neighbor's beacons.
4732   *
4733   * @__NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4734   * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_MAX: highest possible power save level
4735   */
4736  
4737  enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode {
4738  	NL80211_MESH_POWER_UNKNOWN,
4739  	NL80211_MESH_POWER_ACTIVE,
4740  	NL80211_MESH_POWER_LIGHT_SLEEP,
4741  	NL80211_MESH_POWER_DEEP_SLEEP,
4742  
4743  	__NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST,
4744  	NL80211_MESH_POWER_MAX = __NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST - 1
4745  };
4746  
4747  /**
4748   * enum nl80211_meshconf_params - mesh configuration parameters
4749   *
4750   * Mesh configuration parameters. These can be changed while the mesh is
4751   * active.
4752   *
4753   * @__NL80211_MESHCONF_INVALID: internal use
4754   *
4755   * @NL80211_MESHCONF_RETRY_TIMEOUT: specifies the initial retry timeout in
4756   *	millisecond units, used by the Peer Link Open message
4757   *
4758   * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONFIRM_TIMEOUT: specifies the initial confirm timeout, in
4759   *	millisecond units, used by the peer link management to close a peer link
4760   *
4761   * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HOLDING_TIMEOUT: specifies the holding timeout, in
4762   *	millisecond units
4763   *
4764   * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_PEER_LINKS: maximum number of peer links allowed
4765   *	on this mesh interface
4766   *
4767   * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_RETRIES: specifies the maximum number of peer link
4768   *	open retries that can be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a
4769   *	mesh
4770   *
4771   * @NL80211_MESHCONF_TTL: specifies the value of TTL field set at a source mesh
4772   *	point.
4773   *
4774   * @NL80211_MESHCONF_AUTO_OPEN_PLINKS: whether we should automatically open
4775   *	peer links when we detect compatible mesh peers. Disabled if
4776   *	@NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM or @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE are
4777   *	set.
4778   *
4779   * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_MAX_PREQ_RETRIES: the number of action frames
4780   *	containing a PREQ that an MP can send to a particular destination (path
4781   *	target)
4782   *
4783   * @NL80211_MESHCONF_PATH_REFRESH_TIME: how frequently to refresh mesh paths
4784   *	(in milliseconds)
4785   *
4786   * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MIN_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: minimum length of time to wait
4787   *	until giving up on a path discovery (in milliseconds)
4788   *
4789   * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ACTIVE_PATH_TIMEOUT: The time (in TUs) for which mesh
4790   *	points receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from
4791   *	the root to be valid. (TU = time unit)
4792   *
4793   * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PREQ_MIN_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time (in
4794   *	TUs) during which an MP can send only one action frame containing a PREQ
4795   *	reference element
4796   *
4797   * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_NET_DIAM_TRVS_TIME: The interval of time (in TUs)
4798   *	that it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the
4799   *	mesh
4800   *
4801   * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOTMODE: whether root mode is enabled or not
4802   *
4803   * @NL80211_MESHCONF_ELEMENT_TTL: specifies the value of TTL field set at a
4804   *	source mesh point for path selection elements.
4805   *
4806   * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_RANN_INTERVAL:  The interval of time (in TUs) between
4807   *	root announcements are transmitted.
4808   *
4809   * @NL80211_MESHCONF_GATE_ANNOUNCEMENTS: Advertise that this mesh station has
4810   *	access to a broader network beyond the MBSS.  This is done via Root
4811   *	Announcement frames.
4812   *
4813   * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PERR_MIN_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time (in
4814   *	TUs) during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a
4815   *	PERR element.
4816   *
4817   * @NL80211_MESHCONF_FORWARDING: set Mesh STA as forwarding or non-forwarding
4818   *	or forwarding entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity)
4819   *
4820   * @NL80211_MESHCONF_RSSI_THRESHOLD: RSSI threshold in dBm. This specifies the
4821   *	threshold for average signal strength of candidate station to establish
4822   *	a peer link.
4823   *
4824   * @NL80211_MESHCONF_SYNC_OFFSET_MAX_NEIGHBOR: maximum number of neighbors
4825   *	to synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method
4826   *	(see 11C.12.2.2)
4827   *
4828   * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HT_OPMODE: set mesh HT protection mode.
4829   *
4830   * @NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_MAX: highest possible mesh configuration attribute
4831   *
4832   * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PATH_TO_ROOT_TIMEOUT: The time (in TUs) for
4833   *	which mesh STAs receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding
4834   *	information to the root mesh STA to be valid.
4835   *
4836   * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOT_INTERVAL: The interval of time (in TUs) between
4837   *	proactive PREQs are transmitted.
4838   *
4839   * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_CONFIRMATION_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time
4840   *	(in TUs) during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame
4841   *	containing a PREQ element for root path confirmation.
4842   *
4843   * @NL80211_MESHCONF_POWER_MODE: Default mesh power mode for new peer links.
4844   *	type &enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode (u32)
4845   *
4846   * @NL80211_MESHCONF_AWAKE_WINDOW: awake window duration (in TUs)
4847   *
4848   * @NL80211_MESHCONF_PLINK_TIMEOUT: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've
4849   *	established peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then
4850   *	remove it from the STA's list of peers. You may set this to 0 to disable
4851   *	the removal of the STA. Default is 30 minutes.
4852   *
4853   * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_GATE: If set to true then this mesh STA
4854   *	will advertise that it is connected to a gate in the mesh formation
4855   *	field.  If left unset then the mesh formation field will only
4856   *	advertise such if there is an active root mesh path.
4857   *
4858   * @NL80211_MESHCONF_NOLEARN: Try to avoid multi-hop path discovery (e.g.
4859   *      PREQ/PREP for HWMP) if the destination is a direct neighbor. Note that
4860   *      this might not be the optimal decision as a multi-hop route might be
4861   *      better. So if using this setting you will likely also want to disable
4862   *      dot11MeshForwarding and use another mesh routing protocol on top.
4863   *
4864   * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_AS: If set to true then this mesh STA
4865   *	will advertise that it is connected to a authentication server
4866   *	in the mesh formation field.
4867   *
4868   * @__NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4869   */
4870  enum nl80211_meshconf_params {
4871  	__NL80211_MESHCONF_INVALID,
4872  	NL80211_MESHCONF_RETRY_TIMEOUT,
4873  	NL80211_MESHCONF_CONFIRM_TIMEOUT,
4874  	NL80211_MESHCONF_HOLDING_TIMEOUT,
4875  	NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_PEER_LINKS,
4876  	NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_RETRIES,
4877  	NL80211_MESHCONF_TTL,
4878  	NL80211_MESHCONF_AUTO_OPEN_PLINKS,
4879  	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_MAX_PREQ_RETRIES,
4880  	NL80211_MESHCONF_PATH_REFRESH_TIME,
4881  	NL80211_MESHCONF_MIN_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT,
4882  	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ACTIVE_PATH_TIMEOUT,
4883  	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PREQ_MIN_INTERVAL,
4884  	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_NET_DIAM_TRVS_TIME,
4885  	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOTMODE,
4886  	NL80211_MESHCONF_ELEMENT_TTL,
4887  	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_RANN_INTERVAL,
4888  	NL80211_MESHCONF_GATE_ANNOUNCEMENTS,
4889  	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PERR_MIN_INTERVAL,
4890  	NL80211_MESHCONF_FORWARDING,
4891  	NL80211_MESHCONF_RSSI_THRESHOLD,
4892  	NL80211_MESHCONF_SYNC_OFFSET_MAX_NEIGHBOR,
4893  	NL80211_MESHCONF_HT_OPMODE,
4894  	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PATH_TO_ROOT_TIMEOUT,
4895  	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOT_INTERVAL,
4896  	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_CONFIRMATION_INTERVAL,
4897  	NL80211_MESHCONF_POWER_MODE,
4898  	NL80211_MESHCONF_AWAKE_WINDOW,
4899  	NL80211_MESHCONF_PLINK_TIMEOUT,
4900  	NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_GATE,
4901  	NL80211_MESHCONF_NOLEARN,
4902  	NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_AS,
4903  
4904  	/* keep last */
4905  	__NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4906  	NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4907  };
4908  
4909  /**
4910   * enum nl80211_mesh_setup_params - mesh setup parameters
4911   *
4912   * Mesh setup parameters.  These are used to start/join a mesh and cannot be
4913   * changed while the mesh is active.
4914   *
4915   * @__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_INVALID: Internal use
4916   *
4917   * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_PATH_SEL: Enable this option to use a
4918   *	vendor specific path selection algorithm or disable it to use the
4919   *	default HWMP.
4920   *
4921   * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_METRIC: Enable this option to use a
4922   *	vendor specific path metric or disable it to use the default Airtime
4923   *	metric.
4924   *
4925   * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE: Information elements for this mesh, for instance, a
4926   *	robust security network ie, or a vendor specific information element
4927   *	that vendors will use to identify the path selection methods and
4928   *	metrics in use.
4929   *
4930   * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH: Enable this option if an authentication
4931   *	daemon will be authenticating mesh candidates.
4932   *
4933   * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE: Enable this option if an authentication
4934   *	daemon will be securing peer link frames.  AMPE is a secured version of
4935   *	Mesh Peering Management (MPM) and is implemented with the assistance of
4936   *	a userspace daemon.  When this flag is set, the kernel will send peer
4937   *	management frames to a userspace daemon that will implement AMPE
4938   *	functionality (security capabilities selection, key confirmation, and
4939   *	key management).  When the flag is unset (default), the kernel can
4940   *	autonomously complete (unsecured) mesh peering without the need of a
4941   *	userspace daemon.
4942   *
4943   * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_SYNC: Enable this option to use a
4944   *	vendor specific synchronization method or disable it to use the default
4945   *	neighbor offset synchronization
4946   *
4947   * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM: Enable this option if userspace will
4948   *	implement an MPM which handles peer allocation and state.
4949   *
4950   * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_AUTH_PROTOCOL: Inform the kernel of the authentication
4951   *	method (u8, as defined in IEEE 8.4.2.100.6, e.g. 0x1 for SAE).
4952   *	Default is no authentication method required.
4953   *
4954   * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_MAX: highest possible mesh setup attribute number
4955   *
4956   * @__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal use
4957   */
4958  enum nl80211_mesh_setup_params {
4959  	__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_INVALID,
4960  	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_PATH_SEL,
4961  	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_METRIC,
4962  	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE,
4963  	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH,
4964  	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE,
4965  	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_SYNC,
4966  	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM,
4967  	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_AUTH_PROTOCOL,
4968  
4969  	/* keep last */
4970  	__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4971  	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4972  };
4973  
4974  /**
4975   * enum nl80211_txq_attr - TX queue parameter attributes
4976   * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_INVALID: Attribute number 0 is reserved
4977   * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC: AC identifier (NL80211_AC_*)
4978   * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_TXOP: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning
4979   *	disabled
4980   * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMIN: Minimum contention window [a value of the form
4981   *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
4982   * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMAX: Maximum contention window [a value of the form
4983   *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
4984   * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AIFS: Arbitration interframe space [0..255]
4985   * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal
4986   * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_MAX: Maximum TXQ attribute number
4987   */
4988  enum nl80211_txq_attr {
4989  	__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_INVALID,
4990  	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC,
4991  	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_TXOP,
4992  	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMIN,
4993  	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMAX,
4994  	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AIFS,
4995  
4996  	/* keep last */
4997  	__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4998  	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4999  };
5000  
5001  enum nl80211_ac {
5002  	NL80211_AC_VO,
5003  	NL80211_AC_VI,
5004  	NL80211_AC_BE,
5005  	NL80211_AC_BK,
5006  	NL80211_NUM_ACS
5007  };
5008  
5009  /* backward compat */
5010  #define NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_QUEUE	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC
5011  #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_VO	NL80211_AC_VO
5012  #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_VI	NL80211_AC_VI
5013  #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_BE	NL80211_AC_BE
5014  #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_BK	NL80211_AC_BK
5015  
5016  /**
5017   * enum nl80211_channel_type - channel type
5018   * @NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT: 20 MHz, non-HT channel
5019   * @NL80211_CHAN_HT20: 20 MHz HT channel
5020   * @NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS: HT40 channel, secondary channel
5021   *	below the control channel
5022   * @NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS: HT40 channel, secondary channel
5023   *	above the control channel
5024   */
5025  enum nl80211_channel_type {
5026  	NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT,
5027  	NL80211_CHAN_HT20,
5028  	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS,
5029  	NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS
5030  };
5031  
5032  /**
5033   * enum nl80211_key_mode - Key mode
5034   *
5035   * @NL80211_KEY_RX_TX: (Default)
5036   *	Key can be used for Rx and Tx immediately
5037   *
5038   * The following modes can only be selected for unicast keys and when the
5039   * driver supports @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID:
5040   *
5041   * @NL80211_KEY_NO_TX: Only allowed in combination with @NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY:
5042   *	Unicast key can only be used for Rx, Tx not allowed, yet
5043   * @NL80211_KEY_SET_TX: Only allowed in combination with @NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY:
5044   *	The unicast key identified by idx and mac is cleared for Tx and becomes
5045   *	the preferred Tx key for the station.
5046   */
5047  enum nl80211_key_mode {
5048  	NL80211_KEY_RX_TX,
5049  	NL80211_KEY_NO_TX,
5050  	NL80211_KEY_SET_TX
5051  };
5052  
5053  /**
5054   * enum nl80211_chan_width - channel width definitions
5055   *
5056   * These values are used with the %NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH
5057   * attribute.
5058   *
5059   * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT: 20 MHz, non-HT channel
5060   * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20: 20 MHz HT channel
5061   * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40: 40 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
5062   *	attribute must be provided as well
5063   * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80: 80 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
5064   *	attribute must be provided as well
5065   * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80: 80+80 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
5066   *	and %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2 attributes must be provided as well
5067   * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160: 160 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
5068   *	attribute must be provided as well
5069   * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: 5 MHz OFDM channel
5070   * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: 10 MHz OFDM channel
5071   * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_1: 1 MHz OFDM channel
5072   * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_2: 2 MHz OFDM channel
5073   * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_4: 4 MHz OFDM channel
5074   * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_8: 8 MHz OFDM channel
5075   * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_16: 16 MHz OFDM channel
5076   * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_320: 320 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
5077   *	attribute must be provided as well
5078   */
5079  enum nl80211_chan_width {
5080  	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT,
5081  	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
5082  	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40,
5083  	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80,
5084  	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80,
5085  	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160,
5086  	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5,
5087  	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10,
5088  	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_1,
5089  	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_2,
5090  	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_4,
5091  	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_8,
5092  	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_16,
5093  	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_320,
5094  };
5095  
5096  /**
5097   * enum nl80211_bss_scan_width - control channel width for a BSS
5098   *
5099   * These values are used with the %NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH attribute.
5100   *
5101   * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20: control channel is 20 MHz wide or compatible
5102   * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10: control channel is 10 MHz wide
5103   * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5: control channel is 5 MHz wide
5104   * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_1: control channel is 1 MHz wide
5105   * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_2: control channel is 2 MHz wide
5106   */
5107  enum nl80211_bss_scan_width {
5108  	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
5109  	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10,
5110  	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5,
5111  	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_1,
5112  	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_2,
5113  };
5114  
5115  /**
5116   * enum nl80211_bss_use_for - bitmap indicating possible BSS use
5117   * @NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL: Use this BSS for normal "connection",
5118   *	including IBSS/MBSS depending on the type.
5119   * @NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_MLD_LINK: This BSS can be used as a link in an
5120   *	MLO connection. Note that for an MLO connection, all links including
5121   *	the assoc link must have this flag set, and the assoc link must
5122   *	additionally have %NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL set.
5123   */
5124  enum nl80211_bss_use_for {
5125  	NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL = 1 << 0,
5126  	NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_MLD_LINK = 1 << 1,
5127  };
5128  
5129  /**
5130   * enum nl80211_bss_cannot_use_reasons - reason(s) connection to a
5131   *	BSS isn't possible
5132   * @NL80211_BSS_CANNOT_USE_NSTR_NONPRIMARY: NSTR nonprimary links aren't
5133   *	supported by the device, and this BSS entry represents one.
5134   * @NL80211_BSS_CANNOT_USE_6GHZ_PWR_MISMATCH: STA is not supporting
5135   *	the AP power type (SP, VLP, AP) that the AP uses.
5136   */
5137  enum nl80211_bss_cannot_use_reasons {
5138  	NL80211_BSS_CANNOT_USE_NSTR_NONPRIMARY	= 1 << 0,
5139  	NL80211_BSS_CANNOT_USE_6GHZ_PWR_MISMATCH	= 1 << 1,
5140  };
5141  
5142  #define NL80211_BSS_CANNOT_USE_UHB_PWR_MISMATCH \
5143  	NL80211_BSS_CANNOT_USE_6GHZ_PWR_MISMATCH
5144  
5145  /**
5146   * enum nl80211_bss - netlink attributes for a BSS
5147   *
5148   * @__NL80211_BSS_INVALID: invalid
5149   * @NL80211_BSS_BSSID: BSSID of the BSS (6 octets)
5150   * @NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY: frequency in MHz (u32)
5151   * @NL80211_BSS_TSF: TSF of the received probe response/beacon (u64)
5152   *	(if @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA is present then this is known to be
5153   *	from a probe response, otherwise it may be from the same beacon
5154   *	that the NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF will be from)
5155   * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_INTERVAL: beacon interval of the (I)BSS (u16)
5156   * @NL80211_BSS_CAPABILITY: capability field (CPU order, u16)
5157   * @NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS: binary attribute containing the
5158   *	raw information elements from the probe response/beacon (bin);
5159   *	if the %NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES attribute is present and the data is
5160   *	different then the IEs here are from a Probe Response frame; otherwise
5161   *	they are from a Beacon frame.
5162   *	However, if the driver does not indicate the source of the IEs, these
5163   *	IEs may be from either frame subtype.
5164   *	If present, the @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA attribute indicates that the
5165   *	data here is known to be from a probe response, without any heuristics.
5166   * @NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_MBM: signal strength of probe response/beacon
5167   *	in mBm (100 * dBm) (s32)
5168   * @NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_UNSPEC: signal strength of the probe response/beacon
5169   *	in unspecified units, scaled to 0..100 (u8)
5170   * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS: status, if this BSS is "used"
5171   * @NL80211_BSS_SEEN_MS_AGO: age of this BSS entry in ms
5172   * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES: binary attribute containing the raw information
5173   *	elements from a Beacon frame (bin); not present if no Beacon frame has
5174   *	yet been received
5175   * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH: channel width of the control channel
5176   *	(u32, enum nl80211_bss_scan_width) - No longer used!
5177   * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF: TSF of the last received beacon (u64)
5178   *	(not present if no beacon frame has been received yet)
5179   * @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA: the data in @NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS and
5180   *	@NL80211_BSS_TSF is known to be from a probe response (flag attribute)
5181   * @NL80211_BSS_LAST_SEEN_BOOTTIME: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp when this entry
5182   *	was last updated by a received frame. The value is expected to be
5183   *	accurate to about 10ms. (u64, nanoseconds)
5184   * @NL80211_BSS_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
5185   * @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF: the time at the start of reception of the first
5186   *	octet of the timestamp field of the last beacon/probe received for
5187   *	this BSS. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified by
5188   *	@NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID. (u64).
5189   * @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID: the BSS according to which @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF
5190   *	is set.
5191   * @NL80211_BSS_CHAIN_SIGNAL: per-chain signal strength of last BSS update.
5192   *	Contains a nested array of signal strength attributes (u8, dBm),
5193   *	using the nesting index as the antenna number.
5194   * @NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY_OFFSET: frequency offset in KHz
5195   * @NL80211_BSS_MLO_LINK_ID: MLO link ID of the BSS (u8).
5196   * @NL80211_BSS_MLD_ADDR: MLD address of this BSS if connected to it.
5197   * @NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR: u32 bitmap attribute indicating what the BSS can be
5198   *	used for, see &enum nl80211_bss_use_for.
5199   * @NL80211_BSS_CANNOT_USE_REASONS: Indicates the reason that this BSS cannot
5200   *	be used for all or some of the possible uses by the device reporting it,
5201   *	even though its presence was detected.
5202   *	This is a u64 attribute containing a bitmap of values from
5203   *	&enum nl80211_cannot_use_reasons, note that the attribute may be missing
5204   *	if no reasons are specified.
5205   * @__NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST: internal
5206   * @NL80211_BSS_MAX: highest BSS attribute
5207   */
5208  enum nl80211_bss {
5209  	__NL80211_BSS_INVALID,
5210  	NL80211_BSS_BSSID,
5211  	NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY,
5212  	NL80211_BSS_TSF,
5213  	NL80211_BSS_BEACON_INTERVAL,
5214  	NL80211_BSS_CAPABILITY,
5215  	NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS,
5216  	NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_MBM,
5217  	NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
5218  	NL80211_BSS_STATUS,
5219  	NL80211_BSS_SEEN_MS_AGO,
5220  	NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES,
5221  	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH,
5222  	NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF,
5223  	NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA,
5224  	NL80211_BSS_LAST_SEEN_BOOTTIME,
5225  	NL80211_BSS_PAD,
5226  	NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF,
5227  	NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID,
5228  	NL80211_BSS_CHAIN_SIGNAL,
5229  	NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY_OFFSET,
5230  	NL80211_BSS_MLO_LINK_ID,
5231  	NL80211_BSS_MLD_ADDR,
5232  	NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR,
5233  	NL80211_BSS_CANNOT_USE_REASONS,
5234  
5235  	/* keep last */
5236  	__NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST,
5237  	NL80211_BSS_MAX = __NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST - 1
5238  };
5239  
5240  /**
5241   * enum nl80211_bss_status - BSS "status"
5242   * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_AUTHENTICATED: Authenticated with this BSS.
5243   *	Note that this is no longer used since cfg80211 no longer
5244   *	keeps track of whether or not authentication was done with
5245   *	a given BSS.
5246   * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_ASSOCIATED: Associated with this BSS.
5247   * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_IBSS_JOINED: Joined to this IBSS.
5248   *
5249   * The BSS status is a BSS attribute in scan dumps, which
5250   * indicates the status the interface has wrt. this BSS.
5251   */
5252  enum nl80211_bss_status {
5253  	NL80211_BSS_STATUS_AUTHENTICATED,
5254  	NL80211_BSS_STATUS_ASSOCIATED,
5255  	NL80211_BSS_STATUS_IBSS_JOINED,
5256  };
5257  
5258  /**
5259   * enum nl80211_auth_type - AuthenticationType
5260   *
5261   * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_OPEN_SYSTEM: Open System authentication
5262   * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SHARED_KEY: Shared Key authentication (WEP only)
5263   * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FT: Fast BSS Transition (IEEE 802.11r)
5264   * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NETWORK_EAP: Network EAP (some Cisco APs and mainly LEAP)
5265   * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SAE: Simultaneous authentication of equals
5266   * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK: Fast Initial Link Setup shared key
5267   * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK_PFS: Fast Initial Link Setup shared key with PFS
5268   * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_PK: Fast Initial Link Setup public key
5269   * @__NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM: internal
5270   * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_MAX: maximum valid auth algorithm
5271   * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_AUTOMATIC: determine automatically (if necessary by
5272   *	trying multiple times); this is invalid in netlink -- leave out
5273   *	the attribute for this on CONNECT commands.
5274   */
5275  enum nl80211_auth_type {
5276  	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_OPEN_SYSTEM,
5277  	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SHARED_KEY,
5278  	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FT,
5279  	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NETWORK_EAP,
5280  	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SAE,
5281  	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK,
5282  	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK_PFS,
5283  	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_PK,
5284  
5285  	/* keep last */
5286  	__NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM,
5287  	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_MAX = __NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM - 1,
5288  	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_AUTOMATIC
5289  };
5290  
5291  /**
5292   * enum nl80211_key_type - Key Type
5293   * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_GROUP: Group (broadcast/multicast) key
5294   * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_PAIRWISE: Pairwise (unicast/individual) key
5295   * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_PEERKEY: PeerKey (DLS)
5296   * @NUM_NL80211_KEYTYPES: number of defined key types
5297   */
5298  enum nl80211_key_type {
5299  	NL80211_KEYTYPE_GROUP,
5300  	NL80211_KEYTYPE_PAIRWISE,
5301  	NL80211_KEYTYPE_PEERKEY,
5302  
5303  	NUM_NL80211_KEYTYPES
5304  };
5305  
5306  /**
5307   * enum nl80211_mfp - Management frame protection state
5308   * @NL80211_MFP_NO: Management frame protection not used
5309   * @NL80211_MFP_REQUIRED: Management frame protection required
5310   * @NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL: Management frame protection is optional
5311   */
5312  enum nl80211_mfp {
5313  	NL80211_MFP_NO,
5314  	NL80211_MFP_REQUIRED,
5315  	NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL,
5316  };
5317  
5318  enum nl80211_wpa_versions {
5319  	NL80211_WPA_VERSION_1 = 1 << 0,
5320  	NL80211_WPA_VERSION_2 = 1 << 1,
5321  	NL80211_WPA_VERSION_3 = 1 << 2,
5322  };
5323  
5324  /**
5325   * enum nl80211_key_default_types - key default types
5326   * @__NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_INVALID: invalid
5327   * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_UNICAST: key should be used as default
5328   *	unicast key
5329   * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_MULTICAST: key should be used as default
5330   *	multicast key
5331   * @NUM_NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: number of default types
5332   */
5333  enum nl80211_key_default_types {
5334  	__NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_INVALID,
5335  	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_UNICAST,
5336  	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_MULTICAST,
5337  
5338  	NUM_NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES
5339  };
5340  
5341  /**
5342   * enum nl80211_key_attributes - key attributes
5343   * @__NL80211_KEY_INVALID: invalid
5344   * @NL80211_KEY_DATA: (temporal) key data; for TKIP this consists of
5345   *	16 bytes encryption key followed by 8 bytes each for TX and RX MIC
5346   *	keys
5347   * @NL80211_KEY_IDX: key ID (u8, 0-3)
5348   * @NL80211_KEY_CIPHER: key cipher suite (u32, as defined by IEEE 802.11
5349   *	section 7.3.2.25.1, e.g. 0x000FAC04)
5350   * @NL80211_KEY_SEQ: transmit key sequence number (IV/PN) for TKIP and
5351   *	CCMP keys, each six bytes in little endian
5352   * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT: flag indicating default key
5353   * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT: flag indicating default management key
5354   * @NL80211_KEY_TYPE: the key type from enum nl80211_key_type, if not
5355   *	specified the default depends on whether a MAC address was
5356   *	given with the command using the key or not (u32)
5357   * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: A nested attribute containing flags
5358   *	attributes, specifying what a key should be set as default as.
5359   *	See &enum nl80211_key_default_types.
5360   * @NL80211_KEY_MODE: the mode from enum nl80211_key_mode.
5361   *	Defaults to @NL80211_KEY_RX_TX.
5362   * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_BEACON: flag indicating default Beacon frame key
5363   *
5364   * @__NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST: internal
5365   * @NL80211_KEY_MAX: highest key attribute
5366   */
5367  enum nl80211_key_attributes {
5368  	__NL80211_KEY_INVALID,
5369  	NL80211_KEY_DATA,
5370  	NL80211_KEY_IDX,
5371  	NL80211_KEY_CIPHER,
5372  	NL80211_KEY_SEQ,
5373  	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT,
5374  	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT,
5375  	NL80211_KEY_TYPE,
5376  	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES,
5377  	NL80211_KEY_MODE,
5378  	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_BEACON,
5379  
5380  	/* keep last */
5381  	__NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST,
5382  	NL80211_KEY_MAX = __NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST - 1
5383  };
5384  
5385  /**
5386   * enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes - TX rate set attributes
5387   * @__NL80211_TXRATE_INVALID: invalid
5388   * @NL80211_TXRATE_LEGACY: Legacy (non-MCS) rates allowed for TX rate selection
5389   *	in an array of rates as defined in IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 (u8 values with
5390   *	1 = 500 kbps) but without the IE length restriction (at most
5391   *	%NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES in a single array).
5392   * @NL80211_TXRATE_HT: HT (MCS) rates allowed for TX rate selection
5393   *	in an array of MCS numbers.
5394   * @NL80211_TXRATE_VHT: VHT rates allowed for TX rate selection,
5395   *	see &struct nl80211_txrate_vht
5396   * @NL80211_TXRATE_GI: configure GI, see &enum nl80211_txrate_gi
5397   * @NL80211_TXRATE_HE: HE rates allowed for TX rate selection,
5398   *	see &struct nl80211_txrate_he
5399   * @NL80211_TXRATE_HE_GI: configure HE GI, 0.8us, 1.6us and 3.2us.
5400   * @NL80211_TXRATE_HE_LTF: configure HE LTF, 1XLTF, 2XLTF and 4XLTF.
5401   * @__NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST: internal
5402   * @NL80211_TXRATE_MAX: highest TX rate attribute
5403   */
5404  enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes {
5405  	__NL80211_TXRATE_INVALID,
5406  	NL80211_TXRATE_LEGACY,
5407  	NL80211_TXRATE_HT,
5408  	NL80211_TXRATE_VHT,
5409  	NL80211_TXRATE_GI,
5410  	NL80211_TXRATE_HE,
5411  	NL80211_TXRATE_HE_GI,
5412  	NL80211_TXRATE_HE_LTF,
5413  
5414  	/* keep last */
5415  	__NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST,
5416  	NL80211_TXRATE_MAX = __NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST - 1
5417  };
5418  
5419  #define NL80211_TXRATE_MCS NL80211_TXRATE_HT
5420  #define NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX		8
5421  
5422  /**
5423   * struct nl80211_txrate_vht - VHT MCS/NSS txrate bitmap
5424   * @mcs: MCS bitmap table for each NSS (array index 0 for 1 stream, etc.)
5425   */
5426  struct nl80211_txrate_vht {
5427  	__u16 mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX];
5428  };
5429  
5430  #define NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX		8
5431  /**
5432   * struct nl80211_txrate_he - HE MCS/NSS txrate bitmap
5433   * @mcs: MCS bitmap table for each NSS (array index 0 for 1 stream, etc.)
5434   */
5435  struct nl80211_txrate_he {
5436  	__u16 mcs[NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX];
5437  };
5438  
5439  enum nl80211_txrate_gi {
5440  	NL80211_TXRATE_DEFAULT_GI,
5441  	NL80211_TXRATE_FORCE_SGI,
5442  	NL80211_TXRATE_FORCE_LGI,
5443  };
5444  
5445  /**
5446   * enum nl80211_band - Frequency band
5447   * @NL80211_BAND_2GHZ: 2.4 GHz ISM band
5448   * @NL80211_BAND_5GHZ: around 5 GHz band (4.9 - 5.7 GHz)
5449   * @NL80211_BAND_60GHZ: around 60 GHz band (58.32 - 69.12 GHz)
5450   * @NL80211_BAND_6GHZ: around 6 GHz band (5.9 - 7.2 GHz)
5451   * @NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ: around 900MHz, supported by S1G PHYs
5452   * @NL80211_BAND_LC: light communication band (placeholder)
5453   * @NUM_NL80211_BANDS: number of bands, avoid using this in userspace
5454   *	since newer kernel versions may support more bands
5455   */
5456  enum nl80211_band {
5457  	NL80211_BAND_2GHZ,
5458  	NL80211_BAND_5GHZ,
5459  	NL80211_BAND_60GHZ,
5460  	NL80211_BAND_6GHZ,
5461  	NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ,
5462  	NL80211_BAND_LC,
5463  
5464  	NUM_NL80211_BANDS,
5465  };
5466  
5467  /**
5468   * enum nl80211_ps_state - powersave state
5469   * @NL80211_PS_DISABLED: powersave is disabled
5470   * @NL80211_PS_ENABLED: powersave is enabled
5471   */
5472  enum nl80211_ps_state {
5473  	NL80211_PS_DISABLED,
5474  	NL80211_PS_ENABLED,
5475  };
5476  
5477  /**
5478   * enum nl80211_attr_cqm - connection quality monitor attributes
5479   * @__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_INVALID: invalid
5480   * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD: RSSI threshold in dBm. This value specifies
5481   *	the threshold for the RSSI level at which an event will be sent. Zero
5482   *	to disable.  Alternatively, if %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST is
5483   *	set, multiple values can be supplied as a low-to-high sorted array of
5484   *	threshold values in dBm.  Events will be sent when the RSSI value
5485   *	crosses any of the thresholds.
5486   * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_HYST: RSSI hysteresis in dBm. This value specifies
5487   *	the minimum amount the RSSI level must change after an event before a
5488   *	new event may be issued (to reduce effects of RSSI oscillation).
5489   * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT: RSSI threshold event
5490   * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_PKT_LOSS_EVENT: a u32 value indicating that this many
5491   *	consecutive packets were not acknowledged by the peer
5492   * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE: TX error rate in %. Minimum % of TX failures
5493   *	during the given %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL before an
5494   *	%NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM with reported %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE and
5495   *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS is generated.
5496   * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS: number of attempted packets in a given
5497   *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL before %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE is
5498   *	checked.
5499   * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL: interval in seconds. Specifies the periodic
5500   *	interval in which %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS and
5501   *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE must be satisfied before generating an
5502   *	%NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM. Set to 0 to turn off TX error reporting.
5503   * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT: flag attribute that's set in a beacon
5504   *	loss event
5505   * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_LEVEL: the RSSI value in dBm that triggered the
5506   *	RSSI threshold event.
5507   * @__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST: internal
5508   * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_MAX: highest key attribute
5509   */
5510  enum nl80211_attr_cqm {
5511  	__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_INVALID,
5512  	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD,
5513  	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_HYST,
5514  	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT,
5515  	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_PKT_LOSS_EVENT,
5516  	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE,
5517  	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS,
5518  	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL,
5519  	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT,
5520  	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_LEVEL,
5521  
5522  	/* keep last */
5523  	__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST,
5524  	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_MAX = __NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST - 1
5525  };
5526  
5527  /**
5528   * enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event - RSSI threshold event
5529   * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_LOW: The RSSI level is lower than the
5530   *      configured threshold
5531   * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_HIGH: The RSSI is higher than the
5532   *      configured threshold
5533   * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT: (reserved, never sent)
5534   */
5535  enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event {
5536  	NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_LOW,
5537  	NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_HIGH,
5538  	NL80211_CQM_RSSI_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT,
5539  };
5540  
5541  
5542  /**
5543   * enum nl80211_tx_power_setting - TX power adjustment
5544   * @NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC: automatically determine transmit power
5545   * @NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED: limit TX power by the mBm parameter
5546   * @NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED: fix TX power to the mBm parameter
5547   */
5548  enum nl80211_tx_power_setting {
5549  	NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC,
5550  	NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED,
5551  	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED,
5552  };
5553  
5554  /**
5555   * enum nl80211_tid_config - TID config state
5556   * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ENABLE: Enable config for the TID
5557   * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_DISABLE: Disable config for the TID
5558   */
5559  enum nl80211_tid_config {
5560  	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ENABLE,
5561  	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_DISABLE,
5562  };
5563  
5564  /* enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting - TX rate configuration type
5565   * @NL80211_TX_RATE_AUTOMATIC: automatically determine TX rate
5566   * @NL80211_TX_RATE_LIMITED: limit the TX rate by the TX rate parameter
5567   * @NL80211_TX_RATE_FIXED: fix TX rate to the TX rate parameter
5568   */
5569  enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting {
5570  	NL80211_TX_RATE_AUTOMATIC,
5571  	NL80211_TX_RATE_LIMITED,
5572  	NL80211_TX_RATE_FIXED,
5573  };
5574  
5575  /* enum nl80211_tid_config_attr - TID specific configuration.
5576   * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PAD: pad attribute for 64-bit values
5577   * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_VIF_SUPP: a bitmap (u64) of attributes supported
5578   *	for per-vif configuration; doesn't list the ones that are generic
5579   *	(%NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS, %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE).
5580   * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PEER_SUPP: same as the previous per-vif one, but
5581   *	per peer instead.
5582   * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE: flag attribute, if set indicates
5583   *	that the new configuration overrides all previous peer
5584   *	configurations, otherwise previous peer specific configurations
5585   *	should be left untouched.
5586   * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS: a bitmask value of TIDs (bit 0 to 7)
5587   *	Its type is u16.
5588   * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_NOACK: Configure ack policy for the TID.
5589   *	specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TID. see %enum nl80211_tid_config.
5590   *	Its type is u8.
5591   * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT: Number of retries used with data frame
5592   *	transmission, user-space sets this configuration in
5593   *	&NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG. It is u8 type, min value is 1 and
5594   *	the max value is advertised by the driver in this attribute on
5595   *	output in wiphy capabilities.
5596   * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG: Number of retries used with data frame
5597   *	transmission, user-space sets this configuration in
5598   *	&NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG. Its type is u8, min value is 1 and
5599   *	the max value is advertised by the driver in this attribute on
5600   *	output in wiphy capabilities.
5601   * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMPDU_CTRL: Enable/Disable MPDU aggregation
5602   *	for the TIDs specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS.
5603   *	Its type is u8, using the values from &nl80211_tid_config.
5604   * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RTSCTS_CTRL: Enable/Disable RTS_CTS for the TIDs
5605   *	specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS. It is u8 type, using
5606   *	the values from &nl80211_tid_config.
5607   * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMSDU_CTRL: Enable/Disable MSDU aggregation
5608   *	for the TIDs specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS.
5609   *	Its type is u8, using the values from &nl80211_tid_config.
5610   * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE_TYPE: This attribute will be useful
5611   *	to notfiy the driver that what type of txrate should be used
5612   *	for the TIDs specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS. using
5613   *	the values form &nl80211_tx_rate_setting.
5614   * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE: Data frame TX rate mask should be applied
5615   *	with the parameters passed through %NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES.
5616   *	configuration is applied to the data frame for the tid to that connected
5617   *	station.
5618   */
5619  enum nl80211_tid_config_attr {
5620  	__NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_INVALID,
5621  	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PAD,
5622  	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_VIF_SUPP,
5623  	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PEER_SUPP,
5624  	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE,
5625  	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS,
5626  	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_NOACK,
5627  	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT,
5628  	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG,
5629  	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMPDU_CTRL,
5630  	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RTSCTS_CTRL,
5631  	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMSDU_CTRL,
5632  	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE_TYPE,
5633  	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE,
5634  
5635  	/* keep last */
5636  	__NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
5637  	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
5638  };
5639  
5640  /**
5641   * enum nl80211_packet_pattern_attr - packet pattern attribute
5642   * @__NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute
5643   * @NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN: the pattern, values where the mask has
5644   *	a zero bit are ignored
5645   * @NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK: pattern mask, must be long enough to have
5646   *	a bit for each byte in the pattern. The lowest-order bit corresponds
5647   *	to the first byte of the pattern, but the bytes of the pattern are
5648   *	in a little-endian-like format, i.e. the 9th byte of the pattern
5649   *	corresponds to the lowest-order bit in the second byte of the mask.
5650   *	For example: The match 00:xx:00:00:xx:00:00:00:00:xx:xx:xx (where
5651   *	xx indicates "don't care") would be represented by a pattern of
5652   *	twelve zero bytes, and a mask of "0xed,0x01".
5653   *	Note that the pattern matching is done as though frames were not
5654   *	802.11 frames but 802.3 frames, i.e. the frame is fully unpacked
5655   *	first (including SNAP header unpacking) and then matched.
5656   * @NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET: packet offset, pattern is matched after
5657   *	these fixed number of bytes of received packet
5658   * @NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT: number of attributes
5659   * @MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT: max attribute number
5660   */
5661  enum nl80211_packet_pattern_attr {
5662  	__NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID,
5663  	NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK,
5664  	NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN,
5665  	NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET,
5666  
5667  	NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT,
5668  	MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT = NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT - 1,
5669  };
5670  
5671  /**
5672   * struct nl80211_pattern_support - packet pattern support information
5673   * @max_patterns: maximum number of patterns supported
5674   * @min_pattern_len: minimum length of each pattern
5675   * @max_pattern_len: maximum length of each pattern
5676   * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
5677   *
5678   * This struct is carried in %NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN when
5679   * that is part of %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED or in
5680   * %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN when that is part of
5681   * %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE in the capability information given
5682   * by the kernel to userspace.
5683   */
5684  struct nl80211_pattern_support {
5685  	__u32 max_patterns;
5686  	__u32 min_pattern_len;
5687  	__u32 max_pattern_len;
5688  	__u32 max_pkt_offset;
5689  } __attribute__((packed));
5690  
5691  /* only for backward compatibility */
5692  #define __NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_INVALID __NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID
5693  #define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_MASK NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK
5694  #define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_PATTERN NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN
5695  #define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_OFFSET NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET
5696  #define NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT
5697  #define MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT
5698  #define nl80211_wowlan_pattern_support nl80211_pattern_support
5699  
5700  /**
5701   * enum nl80211_wowlan_triggers - WoWLAN trigger definitions
5702   * @__NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
5703   * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_ANY: wake up on any activity, do not really put
5704   *	the chip into a special state -- works best with chips that have
5705   *	support for low-power operation already (flag)
5706   *	Note that this mode is incompatible with all of the others, if
5707   *	any others are even supported by the device.
5708   * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_DISCONNECT: wake up on disconnect, the way disconnect
5709   *	is detected is implementation-specific (flag)
5710   * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_MAGIC_PKT: wake up on magic packet (6x 0xff, followed
5711   *	by 16 repetitions of MAC addr, anywhere in payload) (flag)
5712   * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN: wake up on the specified packet patterns
5713   *	which are passed in an array of nested attributes, each nested attribute
5714   *	defining a with attributes from &struct nl80211_wowlan_trig_pkt_pattern.
5715   *	Each pattern defines a wakeup packet. Packet offset is associated with
5716   *	each pattern which is used while matching the pattern. The matching is
5717   *	done on the MSDU, i.e. as though the packet was an 802.3 packet, so the
5718   *	pattern matching is done after the packet is converted to the MSDU.
5719   *
5720   *	In %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED, it is a binary attribute
5721   *	carrying a &struct nl80211_pattern_support.
5722   *
5723   *	When reporting wakeup. it is a u32 attribute containing the 0-based
5724   *	index of the pattern that caused the wakeup, in the patterns passed
5725   *	to the kernel when configuring.
5726   * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_SUPPORTED: Not a real trigger, and cannot be
5727   *	used when setting, used only to indicate that GTK rekeying is supported
5728   *	by the device (flag)
5729   * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: wake up on GTK rekey failure (if
5730   *	done by the device) (flag)
5731   * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_EAP_IDENT_REQUEST: wake up on EAP Identity Request
5732   *	packet (flag)
5733   * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: wake up on 4-way handshake (flag)
5734   * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_RFKILL_RELEASE: wake up when rfkill is released
5735   *	(on devices that have rfkill in the device) (flag)
5736   * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211: For wakeup reporting only, contains
5737   *	the 802.11 packet that caused the wakeup, e.g. a deauth frame. The frame
5738   *	may be truncated, the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN
5739   *	attribute contains the original length.
5740   * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN: Original length of the 802.11
5741   *	packet, may be bigger than the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211
5742   *	attribute if the packet was truncated somewhere.
5743   * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023: For wakeup reporting only, contains the
5744   *	802.11 packet that caused the wakeup, e.g. a magic packet. The frame may
5745   *	be truncated, the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN attribute
5746   *	contains the original length.
5747   * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN: Original length of the 802.3
5748   *	packet, may be bigger than the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023
5749   *	attribute if the packet was truncated somewhere.
5750   * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_CONNECTION: TCP connection wake, see DOC section
5751   *	"TCP connection wakeup" for more details. This is a nested attribute
5752   *	containing the exact information for establishing and keeping alive
5753   *	the TCP connection.
5754   * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_MATCH: For wakeup reporting only, the
5755   *	wakeup packet was received on the TCP connection
5756   * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_CONNLOST: For wakeup reporting only, the
5757   *	TCP connection was lost or failed to be established
5758   * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_NOMORETOKENS: For wakeup reporting only,
5759   *	the TCP connection ran out of tokens to use for data to send to the
5760   *	service
5761   * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT: wake up when a configured network
5762   *	is detected.  This is a nested attribute that contains the
5763   *	same attributes used with @NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN.  It
5764   *	specifies how the scan is performed (e.g. the interval, the
5765   *	channels to scan and the initial delay) as well as the scan
5766   *	results that will trigger a wake (i.e. the matchsets).  This
5767   *	attribute is also sent in a response to
5768   *	@NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY, indicating the number of match sets
5769   *	supported by the driver (u32).
5770   * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT_RESULTS: nested attribute
5771   *	containing an array with information about what triggered the
5772   *	wake up.  If no elements are present in the array, it means
5773   *	that the information is not available.  If more than one
5774   *	element is present, it means that more than one match
5775   *	occurred.
5776   *	Each element in the array is a nested attribute that contains
5777   *	one optional %NL80211_ATTR_SSID attribute and one optional
5778   *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES attribute.  At least one of
5779   *	these attributes must be present.  If
5780   *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES contains more than one
5781   *	frequency, it means that the match occurred in more than one
5782   *	channel.
5783   * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_UNPROTECTED_DEAUTH_DISASSOC: For wakeup reporting only.
5784   *	Wake up happened due to unprotected deauth or disassoc frame in MFP.
5785   * @NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG: number of wake on wireless triggers
5786   * @MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG: highest wowlan trigger attribute number
5787   *
5788   * These nested attributes are used to configure the wakeup triggers and
5789   * to report the wakeup reason(s).
5790   */
5791  enum nl80211_wowlan_triggers {
5792  	__NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_INVALID,
5793  	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_ANY,
5794  	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_DISCONNECT,
5795  	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_MAGIC_PKT,
5796  	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN,
5797  	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_SUPPORTED,
5798  	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE,
5799  	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_EAP_IDENT_REQUEST,
5800  	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_4WAY_HANDSHAKE,
5801  	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_RFKILL_RELEASE,
5802  	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211,
5803  	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN,
5804  	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023,
5805  	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN,
5806  	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_CONNECTION,
5807  	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_MATCH,
5808  	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_CONNLOST,
5809  	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_NOMORETOKENS,
5810  	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT,
5811  	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT_RESULTS,
5812  	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_UNPROTECTED_DEAUTH_DISASSOC,
5813  
5814  	/* keep last */
5815  	NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG,
5816  	MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG = NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG - 1
5817  };
5818  
5819  /**
5820   * DOC: TCP connection wakeup
5821   *
5822   * Some devices can establish a TCP connection in order to be woken up by a
5823   * packet coming in from outside their network segment, or behind NAT. If
5824   * configured, the device will establish a TCP connection to the given
5825   * service, and periodically send data to that service. The first data
5826   * packet is usually transmitted after SYN/ACK, also ACKing the SYN/ACK.
5827   * The data packets can optionally include a (little endian) sequence
5828   * number (in the TCP payload!) that is generated by the device, and, also
5829   * optionally, a token from a list of tokens. This serves as a keep-alive
5830   * with the service, and for NATed connections, etc.
5831   *
5832   * During this keep-alive period, the server doesn't send any data to the
5833   * client. When receiving data, it is compared against the wakeup pattern
5834   * (and mask) and if it matches, the host is woken up. Similarly, if the
5835   * connection breaks or cannot be established to start with, the host is
5836   * also woken up.
5837   *
5838   * Developer's note: ARP offload is required for this, otherwise TCP
5839   * response packets might not go through correctly.
5840   */
5841  
5842  /**
5843   * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq - WoWLAN TCP data sequence
5844   * @start: starting value
5845   * @offset: offset of sequence number in packet
5846   * @len: length of the sequence value to write, 1 through 4
5847   *
5848   * Note: don't confuse with the TCP sequence number(s), this is for the
5849   * keepalive packet payload. The actual value is written into the packet
5850   * in little endian.
5851   */
5852  struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq {
5853  	__u32 start, offset, len;
5854  };
5855  
5856  /**
5857   * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token - WoWLAN TCP data token config
5858   * @offset: offset of token in packet
5859   * @len: length of each token
5860   * @token_stream: stream of data to be used for the tokens, the length must
5861   *	be a multiple of @len for this to make sense
5862   */
5863  struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token {
5864  	__u32 offset, len;
5865  	__u8 token_stream[];
5866  };
5867  
5868  /**
5869   * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature - data token features
5870   * @min_len: minimum token length
5871   * @max_len: maximum token length
5872   * @bufsize: total available token buffer size (max size of @token_stream)
5873   */
5874  struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature {
5875  	__u32 min_len, max_len, bufsize;
5876  };
5877  
5878  /**
5879   * enum nl80211_wowlan_tcp_attrs - WoWLAN TCP connection parameters
5880   * @__NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
5881   * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_IPV4: source IPv4 address (in network byte order)
5882   * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_IPV4: destination IPv4 address
5883   *	(in network byte order)
5884   * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_MAC: destination MAC address, this is given because
5885   *	route lookup when configured might be invalid by the time we suspend,
5886   *	and doing a route lookup when suspending is no longer possible as it
5887   *	might require ARP querying.
5888   * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_PORT: source port (u16); optional, if not given a
5889   *	socket and port will be allocated
5890   * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_PORT: destination port (u16)
5891   * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD: data packet payload, at least one byte.
5892   *	For feature advertising, a u32 attribute holding the maximum length
5893   *	of the data payload.
5894   * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_SEQ: data packet sequence configuration
5895   *	(if desired), a &struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq. For feature
5896   *	advertising it is just a flag
5897   * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_TOKEN: data packet token configuration,
5898   *	see &struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token and for advertising see
5899   *	&struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature.
5900   * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_INTERVAL: data interval in seconds, maximum
5901   *	interval in feature advertising (u32)
5902   * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_PAYLOAD: wake packet payload, for advertising a
5903   *	u32 attribute holding the maximum length
5904   * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_MASK: Wake packet payload mask, not used for
5905   *	feature advertising. The mask works like @NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK
5906   *	but on the TCP payload only.
5907   * @NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP: number of TCP attributes
5908   * @MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP: highest attribute number
5909   */
5910  enum nl80211_wowlan_tcp_attrs {
5911  	__NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_INVALID,
5912  	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_IPV4,
5913  	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_IPV4,
5914  	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_MAC,
5915  	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_PORT,
5916  	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_PORT,
5917  	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD,
5918  	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_SEQ,
5919  	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_TOKEN,
5920  	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_INTERVAL,
5921  	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_PAYLOAD,
5922  	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_MASK,
5923  
5924  	/* keep last */
5925  	NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP,
5926  	MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP = NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP - 1
5927  };
5928  
5929  /**
5930   * struct nl80211_coalesce_rule_support - coalesce rule support information
5931   * @max_rules: maximum number of rules supported
5932   * @pat: packet pattern support information
5933   * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs
5934   *
5935   * This struct is carried in %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE in the
5936   * capability information given by the kernel to userspace.
5937   */
5938  struct nl80211_coalesce_rule_support {
5939  	__u32 max_rules;
5940  	struct nl80211_pattern_support pat;
5941  	__u32 max_delay;
5942  } __attribute__((packed));
5943  
5944  /**
5945   * enum nl80211_attr_coalesce_rule - coalesce rule attribute
5946   * @__NL80211_COALESCE_RULE_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute
5947   * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_DELAY: delay in msecs used for packet coalescing
5948   * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_CONDITION: condition for packet coalescence,
5949   *	see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition.
5950   * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN: packet offset, pattern is matched
5951   *	after these fixed number of bytes of received packet
5952   * @NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE: number of attributes
5953   * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_MAX: max attribute number
5954   */
5955  enum nl80211_attr_coalesce_rule {
5956  	__NL80211_COALESCE_RULE_INVALID,
5957  	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_DELAY,
5958  	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_CONDITION,
5959  	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN,
5960  
5961  	/* keep last */
5962  	NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE,
5963  	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE - 1
5964  };
5965  
5966  /**
5967   * enum nl80211_coalesce_condition - coalesce rule conditions
5968   * @NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_MATCH: coalesce Rx packets when patterns
5969   *	in a rule are matched.
5970   * @NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_NO_MATCH: coalesce Rx packets when patterns
5971   *	in a rule are not matched.
5972   */
5973  enum nl80211_coalesce_condition {
5974  	NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_MATCH,
5975  	NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_NO_MATCH
5976  };
5977  
5978  /**
5979   * enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs - limit attributes
5980   * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_UNSPEC: (reserved)
5981   * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_MAX: maximum number of interfaces that
5982   *	can be chosen from this set of interface types (u32)
5983   * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_TYPES: nested attribute containing a
5984   *	flag attribute for each interface type in this set
5985   * @NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT: number of attributes
5986   * @MAX_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT: highest attribute number
5987   */
5988  enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs {
5989  	NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_UNSPEC,
5990  	NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_MAX,
5991  	NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_TYPES,
5992  
5993  	/* keep last */
5994  	NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT,
5995  	MAX_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT = NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT - 1
5996  };
5997  
5998  /**
5999   * enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs -- interface combination attributes
6000   *
6001   * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_UNSPEC: (reserved)
6002   * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_LIMITS: Nested attributes containing the limits
6003   *	for given interface types, see &enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs.
6004   * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_MAXNUM: u32 attribute giving the total number of
6005   *	interfaces that can be created in this group. This number doesn't
6006   *	apply to interfaces purely managed in software, which are listed
6007   *	in a separate attribute %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACES_SOFTWARE.
6008   * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_STA_AP_BI_MATCH: flag attribute specifying that
6009   *	beacon intervals within this group must be all the same even for
6010   *	infrastructure and AP/GO combinations, i.e. the GO(s) must adopt
6011   *	the infrastructure network's beacon interval.
6012   * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_NUM_CHANNELS: u32 attribute specifying how many
6013   *	different channels may be used within this group.
6014   * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_WIDTHS: u32 attribute containing the bitmap
6015   *	of supported channel widths for radar detection.
6016   * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_REGIONS: u32 attribute containing the bitmap
6017   *	of supported regulatory regions for radar detection.
6018   * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_BI_MIN_GCD: u32 attribute specifying the minimum GCD of
6019   *	different beacon intervals supported by all the interface combinations
6020   *	in this group (if not present, all beacon intervals be identical).
6021   * @NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB: number of attributes
6022   * @MAX_NL80211_IFACE_COMB: highest attribute number
6023   *
6024   * Examples:
6025   *	limits = [ #{STA} <= 1, #{AP} <= 1 ], matching BI, channels = 1, max = 2
6026   *	=> allows an AP and a STA that must match BIs
6027   *
6028   *	numbers = [ #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8 ], BI min gcd, channels = 1, max = 8,
6029   *	=> allows 8 of AP/GO that can have BI gcd >= min gcd
6030   *
6031   *	numbers = [ #{STA} <= 2 ], channels = 2, max = 2
6032   *	=> allows two STAs on the same or on different channels
6033   *
6034   *	numbers = [ #{STA} <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 ], max = 4
6035   *	=> allows a STA plus three P2P interfaces
6036   *
6037   * The list of these four possibilities could completely be contained
6038   * within the %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS attribute to indicate
6039   * that any of these groups must match.
6040   *
6041   * "Combinations" of just a single interface will not be listed here,
6042   * a single interface of any valid interface type is assumed to always
6043   * be possible by itself. This means that implicitly, for each valid
6044   * interface type, the following group always exists:
6045   *	numbers = [ #{<type>} <= 1 ], channels = 1, max = 1
6046   */
6047  enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs {
6048  	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_UNSPEC,
6049  	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_LIMITS,
6050  	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_MAXNUM,
6051  	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_STA_AP_BI_MATCH,
6052  	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_NUM_CHANNELS,
6053  	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_WIDTHS,
6054  	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_REGIONS,
6055  	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_BI_MIN_GCD,
6056  
6057  	/* keep last */
6058  	NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB,
6059  	MAX_NL80211_IFACE_COMB = NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB - 1
6060  };
6061  
6062  
6063  /**
6064   * enum nl80211_plink_state - state of a mesh peer link finite state machine
6065   *
6066   * @NL80211_PLINK_LISTEN: initial state, considered the implicit
6067   *	state of non-existent mesh peer links
6068   * @NL80211_PLINK_OPN_SNT: mesh plink open frame has been sent to
6069   *	this mesh peer
6070   * @NL80211_PLINK_OPN_RCVD: mesh plink open frame has been received
6071   *	from this mesh peer
6072   * @NL80211_PLINK_CNF_RCVD: mesh plink confirm frame has been
6073   *	received from this mesh peer
6074   * @NL80211_PLINK_ESTAB: mesh peer link is established
6075   * @NL80211_PLINK_HOLDING: mesh peer link is being closed or cancelled
6076   * @NL80211_PLINK_BLOCKED: all frames transmitted from this mesh
6077   *	plink are discarded, except for authentication frames
6078   * @NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES: number of peer link states
6079   * @MAX_NL80211_PLINK_STATES: highest numerical value of plink states
6080   */
6081  enum nl80211_plink_state {
6082  	NL80211_PLINK_LISTEN,
6083  	NL80211_PLINK_OPN_SNT,
6084  	NL80211_PLINK_OPN_RCVD,
6085  	NL80211_PLINK_CNF_RCVD,
6086  	NL80211_PLINK_ESTAB,
6087  	NL80211_PLINK_HOLDING,
6088  	NL80211_PLINK_BLOCKED,
6089  
6090  	/* keep last */
6091  	NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES,
6092  	MAX_NL80211_PLINK_STATES = NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES - 1
6093  };
6094  
6095  /**
6096   * enum nl80211_plink_action - actions to perform in mesh peers
6097   *
6098   * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_NO_ACTION: perform no action
6099   * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_OPEN: start mesh peer link establishment
6100   * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_BLOCK: block traffic from this mesh peer
6101   * @NUM_NL80211_PLINK_ACTIONS: number of possible actions
6102   */
6103  enum nl80211_plink_action {
6104  	NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_NO_ACTION,
6105  	NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_OPEN,
6106  	NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_BLOCK,
6107  
6108  	NUM_NL80211_PLINK_ACTIONS,
6109  };
6110  
6111  
6112  #define NL80211_KCK_LEN			16
6113  #define NL80211_KEK_LEN			16
6114  #define NL80211_KCK_EXT_LEN		24
6115  #define NL80211_KEK_EXT_LEN		32
6116  #define NL80211_KCK_EXT_LEN_32		32
6117  #define NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN		8
6118  
6119  /**
6120   * enum nl80211_rekey_data - attributes for GTK rekey offload
6121   * @__NL80211_REKEY_DATA_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
6122   * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KEK: key encryption key (binary)
6123   * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KCK: key confirmation key (binary)
6124   * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_REPLAY_CTR: replay counter (binary)
6125   * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_AKM: AKM data (OUI, suite type)
6126   * @NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA: number of rekey attributes (internal)
6127   * @MAX_NL80211_REKEY_DATA: highest rekey attribute (internal)
6128   */
6129  enum nl80211_rekey_data {
6130  	__NL80211_REKEY_DATA_INVALID,
6131  	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KEK,
6132  	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KCK,
6133  	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_REPLAY_CTR,
6134  	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_AKM,
6135  
6136  	/* keep last */
6137  	NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA,
6138  	MAX_NL80211_REKEY_DATA = NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA - 1
6139  };
6140  
6141  /**
6142   * enum nl80211_hidden_ssid - values for %NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID
6143   * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_NOT_IN_USE: do not hide SSID (i.e., broadcast it in
6144   *	Beacon frames)
6145   * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_LEN: hide SSID by using zero-length SSID element
6146   *	in Beacon frames
6147   * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_CONTENTS: hide SSID by using correct length of SSID
6148   *	element in Beacon frames but zero out each byte in the SSID
6149   */
6150  enum nl80211_hidden_ssid {
6151  	NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_NOT_IN_USE,
6152  	NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_LEN,
6153  	NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_CONTENTS
6154  };
6155  
6156  /**
6157   * enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr - station WME attributes
6158   * @__NL80211_STA_WME_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute
6159   * @NL80211_STA_WME_UAPSD_QUEUES: bitmap of uapsd queues. the format
6160   *	is the same as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field.
6161   * @NL80211_STA_WME_MAX_SP: max service period. the format is the same
6162   *	as the MAX_SP field in the QoS info field (but already shifted down).
6163   * @__NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST: internal
6164   * @NL80211_STA_WME_MAX: highest station WME attribute
6165   */
6166  enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr {
6167  	__NL80211_STA_WME_INVALID,
6168  	NL80211_STA_WME_UAPSD_QUEUES,
6169  	NL80211_STA_WME_MAX_SP,
6170  
6171  	/* keep last */
6172  	__NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST,
6173  	NL80211_STA_WME_MAX = __NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST - 1
6174  };
6175  
6176  /**
6177   * enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr - attributes for PMKSA caching candidates
6178   * @__NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
6179   * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INDEX: candidate index (u32; the smaller, the higher
6180   *	priority)
6181   * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_BSSID: candidate BSSID (6 octets)
6182   * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_PREAUTH: RSN pre-authentication supported (flag)
6183   * @NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: number of PMKSA caching candidate attributes
6184   *	(internal)
6185   * @MAX_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: highest PMKSA caching candidate attribute
6186   *	(internal)
6187   */
6188  enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr {
6189  	__NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INVALID,
6190  	NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INDEX,
6191  	NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_BSSID,
6192  	NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_PREAUTH,
6193  
6194  	/* keep last */
6195  	NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE,
6196  	MAX_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE = NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE - 1
6197  };
6198  
6199  /**
6200   * enum nl80211_tdls_operation - values for %NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION
6201   * @NL80211_TDLS_DISCOVERY_REQ: Send a TDLS discovery request
6202   * @NL80211_TDLS_SETUP: Setup TDLS link
6203   * @NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN: Teardown a TDLS link which is already established
6204   * @NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK: Enable TDLS link
6205   * @NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK: Disable TDLS link
6206   */
6207  enum nl80211_tdls_operation {
6208  	NL80211_TDLS_DISCOVERY_REQ,
6209  	NL80211_TDLS_SETUP,
6210  	NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN,
6211  	NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK,
6212  	NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK,
6213  };
6214  
6215  /**
6216   * enum nl80211_ap_sme_features - device-integrated AP features
6217   * @NL80211_AP_SME_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD: SA Query procedures offloaded to driver
6218   *	when user space indicates support for SA Query procedures offload during
6219   *	"start ap" with %NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT.
6220   */
6221  enum nl80211_ap_sme_features {
6222  	NL80211_AP_SME_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD		= 1 << 0,
6223  };
6224  
6225  /**
6226   * enum nl80211_feature_flags - device/driver features
6227   * @NL80211_FEATURE_SK_TX_STATUS: This driver supports reflecting back
6228   *	TX status to the socket error queue when requested with the
6229   *	socket option.
6230   * @NL80211_FEATURE_HT_IBSS: This driver supports IBSS with HT datarates.
6231   * @NL80211_FEATURE_INACTIVITY_TIMER: This driver takes care of freeing up
6232   *	the connected inactive stations in AP mode.
6233   * @NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS: This driver has been tested
6234   *	to work properly to support receiving regulatory hints from
6235   *	cellular base stations.
6236   * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_DEVICE_NEEDS_CHANNEL: (no longer available, only
6237   *	here to reserve the value for API/ABI compatibility)
6238   * @NL80211_FEATURE_SAE: This driver supports simultaneous authentication of
6239   *	equals (SAE) with user space SME (NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE) in station
6240   *	mode
6241   * @NL80211_FEATURE_LOW_PRIORITY_SCAN: This driver supports low priority scan
6242   * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_FLUSH: Scan flush is supported
6243   * @NL80211_FEATURE_AP_SCAN: Support scanning using an AP vif
6244   * @NL80211_FEATURE_VIF_TXPOWER: The driver supports per-vif TX power setting
6245   * @NL80211_FEATURE_NEED_OBSS_SCAN: The driver expects userspace to perform
6246   *	OBSS scans and generate 20/40 BSS coex reports. This flag is used only
6247   *	for drivers implementing the CONNECT API, for AUTH/ASSOC it is implied.
6248   * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_CTWIN: P2P GO implementation supports CT Window
6249   *	setting
6250   * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_OPPPS: P2P GO implementation supports opportunistic
6251   *	powersave
6252   * @NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE: The driver supports full state
6253   *	transitions for AP clients. Without this flag (and if the driver
6254   *	doesn't have the AP SME in the device) the driver supports adding
6255   *	stations only when they're associated and adds them in associated
6256   *	state (to later be transitioned into authorized), with this flag
6257   *	they should be added before even sending the authentication reply
6258   *	and then transitioned into authenticated, associated and authorized
6259   *	states using station flags.
6260   *	Note that even for drivers that support this, the default is to add
6261   *	stations in authenticated/associated state, so to add unauthenticated
6262   *	stations the authenticated/associated bits have to be set in the mask.
6263   * @NL80211_FEATURE_ADVERTISE_CHAN_LIMITS: cfg80211 advertises channel limits
6264   *	(HT40, VHT 80/160 MHz) if this flag is set
6265   * @NL80211_FEATURE_USERSPACE_MPM: This driver supports a userspace Mesh
6266   *	Peering Management entity which may be implemented by registering for
6267   *	beacons or NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE events. The mesh beacon is
6268   *	still generated by the driver.
6269   * @NL80211_FEATURE_ACTIVE_MONITOR: This driver supports an active monitor
6270   *	interface. An active monitor interface behaves like a normal monitor
6271   *	interface, but gets added to the driver. It ensures that incoming
6272   *	unicast packets directed at the configured interface address get ACKed.
6273   * @NL80211_FEATURE_AP_MODE_CHAN_WIDTH_CHANGE: This driver supports dynamic
6274   *	channel bandwidth change (e.g., HT 20 <-> 40 MHz channel) during the
6275   *	lifetime of a BSS.
6276   * @NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES: This device adds a DS Parameter
6277   *	Set IE to probe requests.
6278   * @NL80211_FEATURE_WFA_TPC_IE_IN_PROBES: This device adds a WFA TPC Report IE
6279   *	to probe requests.
6280   * @NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET: This device, in client mode, supports Quiet Period
6281   *	requests sent to it by an AP.
6282   * @NL80211_FEATURE_TX_POWER_INSERTION: This device is capable of inserting the
6283   *	current tx power value into the TPC Report IE in the spectrum
6284   *	management TPC Report action frame, and in the Radio Measurement Link
6285   *	Measurement Report action frame.
6286   * @NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION: This driver supports dynamic ACK timeout
6287   *	estimation (dynack). %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK flag attribute is used
6288   *	to enable dynack.
6289   * @NL80211_FEATURE_STATIC_SMPS: Device supports static spatial
6290   *	multiplexing powersave, ie. can turn off all but one chain
6291   *	even on HT connections that should be using more chains.
6292   * @NL80211_FEATURE_DYNAMIC_SMPS: Device supports dynamic spatial
6293   *	multiplexing powersave, ie. can turn off all but one chain
6294   *	and then wake the rest up as required after, for example,
6295   *	rts/cts handshake.
6296   * @NL80211_FEATURE_SUPPORTS_WMM_ADMISSION: the device supports setting up WMM
6297   *	TSPEC sessions (TID aka TSID 0-7) with the %NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS
6298   *	command. Standard IEEE 802.11 TSPEC setup is not yet supported, it
6299   *	needs to be able to handle Block-Ack agreements and other things.
6300   * @NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE: Device supports configuring
6301   *	the vif's MAC address upon creation.
6302   *	See 'macaddr' field in the vif_params (cfg80211.h).
6303   * @NL80211_FEATURE_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Driver supports channel switching when
6304   *	operating as a TDLS peer.
6305   * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports using a
6306   *	random MAC address during scan (if the device is unassociated); the
6307   *	%NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR flag may be set for scans and the MAC
6308   *	address mask/value will be used.
6309   * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports
6310   *	using a random MAC address for every scan iteration during scheduled
6311   *	scan (while not associated), the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR may
6312   *	be set for scheduled scan and the MAC address mask/value will be used.
6313   * @NL80211_FEATURE_ND_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports using a
6314   *	random MAC address for every scan iteration during "net detect", i.e.
6315   *	scan in unassociated WoWLAN, the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR may
6316   *	be set for scheduled scan and the MAC address mask/value will be used.
6317   */
6318  enum nl80211_feature_flags {
6319  	NL80211_FEATURE_SK_TX_STATUS			= 1 << 0,
6320  	NL80211_FEATURE_HT_IBSS				= 1 << 1,
6321  	NL80211_FEATURE_INACTIVITY_TIMER		= 1 << 2,
6322  	NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS		= 1 << 3,
6323  	NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_DEVICE_NEEDS_CHANNEL	= 1 << 4,
6324  	NL80211_FEATURE_SAE				= 1 << 5,
6325  	NL80211_FEATURE_LOW_PRIORITY_SCAN		= 1 << 6,
6326  	NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_FLUSH			= 1 << 7,
6327  	NL80211_FEATURE_AP_SCAN				= 1 << 8,
6328  	NL80211_FEATURE_VIF_TXPOWER			= 1 << 9,
6329  	NL80211_FEATURE_NEED_OBSS_SCAN			= 1 << 10,
6330  	NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_CTWIN			= 1 << 11,
6331  	NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_OPPPS			= 1 << 12,
6332  	/* bit 13 is reserved */
6333  	NL80211_FEATURE_ADVERTISE_CHAN_LIMITS		= 1 << 14,
6334  	NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE		= 1 << 15,
6335  	NL80211_FEATURE_USERSPACE_MPM			= 1 << 16,
6336  	NL80211_FEATURE_ACTIVE_MONITOR			= 1 << 17,
6337  	NL80211_FEATURE_AP_MODE_CHAN_WIDTH_CHANGE	= 1 << 18,
6338  	NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES	= 1 << 19,
6339  	NL80211_FEATURE_WFA_TPC_IE_IN_PROBES		= 1 << 20,
6340  	NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET				= 1 << 21,
6341  	NL80211_FEATURE_TX_POWER_INSERTION		= 1 << 22,
6342  	NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION		= 1 << 23,
6343  	NL80211_FEATURE_STATIC_SMPS			= 1 << 24,
6344  	NL80211_FEATURE_DYNAMIC_SMPS			= 1 << 25,
6345  	NL80211_FEATURE_SUPPORTS_WMM_ADMISSION		= 1 << 26,
6346  	NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE			= 1 << 27,
6347  	NL80211_FEATURE_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH		= 1 << 28,
6348  	NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR		= 1 << 29,
6349  	NL80211_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR	= 1 << 30,
6350  	NL80211_FEATURE_ND_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR		= 1U << 31,
6351  };
6352  
6353  /**
6354   * enum nl80211_ext_feature_index - bit index of extended features.
6355   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VHT_IBSS: This driver supports IBSS with VHT datarates.
6356   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM: This driver supports RRM. When featured, user can
6357   *	request to use RRM (see %NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM) with
6358   *	%NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests, which will set
6359   *	the ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM flag in the association request even if
6360   *	NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET is not advertised.
6361   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MU_MIMO_AIR_SNIFFER: This device supports MU-MIMO air
6362   *	sniffer which means that it can be configured to hear packets from
6363   *	certain groups which can be configured by the
6364   *	%NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA attribute,
6365   *	or can be configured to follow a station by configuring the
6366   *	%NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR attribute.
6367   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_START_TIME: This driver includes the actual
6368   *	time the scan started in scan results event. The time is the TSF of
6369   *	the BSS that the interface that requested the scan is connected to
6370   *	(if available).
6371   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_PARENT_TSF: Per BSS, this driver reports the
6372   *	time the last beacon/probe was received. For a non-MLO connection, the
6373   *	time is the TSF of the BSS that the interface that requested the scan is
6374   *	connected to (if available). For an MLO connection, the time is the TSF
6375   *	of the BSS corresponding with link ID specified in the scan request (if
6376   *	specified).
6377   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SET_SCAN_DWELL: This driver supports configuration of
6378   *	channel dwell time.
6379   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY: Driver supports beacon rate
6380   *	configuration (AP/mesh), supporting a legacy (non-HT/VHT) rate.
6381   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT: Driver supports beacon rate
6382   *	configuration (AP/mesh) with HT rates.
6383   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT: Driver supports beacon rate
6384   *	configuration (AP/mesh) with VHT rates.
6385   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_STA: This driver supports Fast Initial Link Setup
6386   *	with user space SME (NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE) in station mode.
6387   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA: This driver supports randomized TA
6388   *	in @NL80211_CMD_FRAME while not associated.
6389   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA_CONNECTED: This driver supports
6390   *	randomized TA in @NL80211_CMD_FRAME while associated.
6391   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI: The driver supports sched_scan
6392   *	for reporting BSSs with better RSSI than the current connected BSS
6393   *	(%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI).
6394   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST: With this driver the
6395   *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD attribute accepts a list of zero or more
6396   *	RSSI threshold values to monitor rather than exactly one threshold.
6397   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD: Driver SME supports FILS shared key
6398   *	authentication with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
6399   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK: Device wants to do 4-way
6400   *	handshake with PSK in station mode (PSK is passed as part of the connect
6401   *	and associate commands), doing it in the host might not be supported.
6402   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X: Device wants to do doing 4-way
6403   *	handshake with 802.1X in station mode (will pass EAP frames to the host
6404   *	and accept the set_pmk/del_pmk commands), doing it in the host might not
6405   *	be supported.
6406   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME: Driver is capable of overriding
6407   *	the max channel attribute in the FILS request params IE with the
6408   *	actual dwell time.
6409   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Driver accepts broadcast probe
6410   *	response
6411   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE: Driver supports sending
6412   *	the first probe request in each channel at rate of at least 5.5Mbps.
6413   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION: Driver supports
6414   *	probe request tx deferral and suppression
6415   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MFP_OPTIONAL: Driver supports the %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL
6416   *	value in %NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP.
6417   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_SPAN_SCAN: Driver supports low span scan.
6418   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_POWER_SCAN: Driver supports low power scan.
6419   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_HIGH_ACCURACY_SCAN: Driver supports high accuracy scan.
6420   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD: HW/driver will offload DFS actions.
6421   *	Device or driver will do all DFS-related actions by itself,
6422   *	informing user-space about CAC progress, radar detection event,
6423   *	channel change triggered by radar detection event.
6424   *	No need to start CAC from user-space, no need to react to
6425   *	"radar detected" event.
6426   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211: Driver supports sending and
6427   *	receiving control port frames over nl80211 instead of the netdevice.
6428   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT: This driver/device supports
6429   *	(average) ACK signal strength reporting.
6430   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DATA_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT: Backward-compatible ID
6431   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_TXQS: Driver supports FQ-CoDel-enabled intermediate
6432   *      TXQs.
6433   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_SN: Driver/device supports randomizing the
6434   *	SN in probe request frames if requested by %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN.
6435   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT: Driver/device can omit all data
6436   *	except for supported rates from the probe request content if requested
6437   *	by the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT flag.
6438   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ENABLE_FTM_RESPONDER: Driver supports enabling fine
6439   *	timing measurement responder role.
6440   *
6441   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0: Driver/device confirm that they are
6442   *      able to rekey an in-use key correctly. Userspace must not rekey PTK keys
6443   *      if this flag is not set. Ignoring this can leak clear text packets and/or
6444   *      freeze the connection.
6445   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID: Driver supports "Extended Key ID for
6446   *      Individually Addressed Frames" from IEEE802.11-2016.
6447   *
6448   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AIRTIME_FAIRNESS: Driver supports getting airtime
6449   *	fairness for transmitted packets and has enabled airtime fairness
6450   *	scheduling.
6451   *
6452   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AP_PMKSA_CACHING: Driver/device supports PMKSA caching
6453   *	(set/del PMKSA operations) in AP mode.
6454   *
6455   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD: Obsolete
6456   *
6457   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_STA_TX_PWR: This driver supports controlling tx power
6458   *	to a station.
6459   *
6460   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD: Device wants to do SAE authentication in
6461   *	station mode (SAE password is passed as part of the connect command).
6462   *
6463   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD: The driver supports a single netdev
6464   *	with VLAN tagged frames and separate VLAN-specific netdevs added using
6465   *	vconfig similarly to the Ethernet case.
6466   *
6467   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AQL: The driver supports the Airtime Queue Limit (AQL)
6468   *	feature, which prevents bufferbloat by using the expected transmission
6469   *	time to limit the amount of data buffered in the hardware.
6470   *
6471   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION: The driver supports Beacon protection
6472   *	and can receive key configuration for BIGTK using key indexes 6 and 7.
6473   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION_CLIENT: The driver supports Beacon
6474   *	protection as a client only and cannot transmit protected beacons.
6475   *
6476   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH: The driver can disable the
6477   *	forwarding of preauth frames over the control port. They are then
6478   *	handled as ordinary data frames.
6479   *
6480   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROTECTED_TWT: Driver supports protected TWT frames
6481   *
6482   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DEL_IBSS_STA: The driver supports removing stations
6483   *      in IBSS mode, essentially by dropping their state.
6484   *
6485   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MULTICAST_REGISTRATIONS: management frame registrations
6486   *	are possible for multicast frames and those will be reported properly.
6487   *
6488   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ: This driver supports receiving and
6489   *	reporting scan request with %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ. In order to
6490   *	report %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ, %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FREQ_KHZ must be
6491   *	included in the scan request.
6492   *
6493   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211_TX_STATUS: The driver
6494   *	can report tx status for control port over nl80211 tx operations.
6495   *
6496   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OPERATING_CHANNEL_VALIDATION: Driver supports Operating
6497   *	Channel Validation (OCV) when using driver's SME for RSNA handshakes.
6498   *
6499   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_AP_PSK: Device wants to do 4-way
6500   *	handshake with PSK in AP mode (PSK is passed as part of the start AP
6501   *	command).
6502   *
6503   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD_AP: Device wants to do SAE authentication
6504   *	in AP mode (SAE password is passed as part of the start AP command).
6505   *
6506   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_DISCOVERY: Driver/device supports FILS discovery
6507   *	frames transmission
6508   *
6509   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Driver/device supports
6510   *	unsolicited broadcast probe response transmission
6511   *
6512   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HE: Driver supports beacon rate
6513   *	configuration (AP/mesh) with HE rates.
6514   *
6515   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_LTF: Device supports secure LTF measurement
6516   *      exchange protocol.
6517   *
6518   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_RTT: Device supports secure RTT measurement
6519   *      exchange protocol.
6520   *
6521   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROT_RANGE_NEGO_AND_MEASURE: Device supports management
6522   *      frame protection for all management frames exchanged during the
6523   *      negotiation and range measurement procedure.
6524   *
6525   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_COLOR: The driver supports BSS color collision
6526   *	detection and change announcemnts.
6527   *
6528   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_CRYPTO_OFFLOAD: Driver running in AP mode supports
6529   *	FILS encryption and decryption for (Re)Association Request and Response
6530   *	frames. Userspace has to share FILS AAD details to the driver by using
6531   *	@NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD.
6532   *
6533   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RADAR_BACKGROUND: Device supports background radar/CAC
6534   *	detection.
6535   *
6536   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_POWERED_ADDR_CHANGE: Device can perform a MAC address
6537   *	change without having to bring the underlying network device down
6538   *	first. For example, in station mode this can be used to vary the
6539   *	origin MAC address prior to a connection to a new AP for privacy
6540   *	or other reasons. Note that certain driver specific restrictions
6541   *	might apply, e.g. no scans in progress, no offchannel operations
6542   *	in progress, and no active connections.
6543   *
6544   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PUNCT: Driver supports preamble puncturing in AP mode.
6545   *
6546   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_NAN: Device supports NAN Pairing which enables
6547   *	authentication, data encryption and message integrity.
6548   *
6549   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AUTH_AND_DEAUTH_RANDOM_TA: Device supports randomized TA
6550   *	in authentication and deauthentication frames sent to unassociated peer
6551   *	using @NL80211_CMD_FRAME.
6552   *
6553   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD: Driver/Device wants to do OWE DH IE
6554   *	handling in station mode.
6555   *
6556   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD_AP: Driver/Device wants to do OWE DH IE
6557   *	handling in AP mode.
6558   *
6559   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_CONCURRENT: The device supports peer-to-peer or
6560   *	ad hoc operation on DFS channels under the control of a concurrent
6561   *	DFS master on the same channel as described in FCC-594280 D01
6562   *	(Section B.3). This, for example, allows P2P GO and P2P clients to
6563   *	operate on DFS channels as long as there's a concurrent BSS connection.
6564   *
6565   * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SPP_AMSDU_SUPPORT: The driver has support for SPP
6566   *	(signaling and payload protected) A-MSDUs and this shall be advertised
6567   *	in the RSNXE.
6568   *
6569   * @NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES: number of extended features.
6570   * @MAX_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES: highest extended feature index.
6571   */
6572  enum nl80211_ext_feature_index {
6573  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VHT_IBSS,
6574  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM,
6575  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MU_MIMO_AIR_SNIFFER,
6576  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_START_TIME,
6577  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_PARENT_TSF,
6578  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SET_SCAN_DWELL,
6579  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY,
6580  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT,
6581  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT,
6582  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_STA,
6583  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA,
6584  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA_CONNECTED,
6585  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI,
6586  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST,
6587  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD,
6588  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK,
6589  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X,
6590  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME,
6591  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP,
6592  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE,
6593  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION,
6594  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MFP_OPTIONAL,
6595  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_SPAN_SCAN,
6596  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_POWER_SCAN,
6597  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_HIGH_ACCURACY_SCAN,
6598  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD,
6599  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211,
6600  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT,
6601  	/* we renamed this - stay compatible */
6602  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DATA_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT = NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT,
6603  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_TXQS,
6604  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_SN,
6605  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT,
6606  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0,
6607  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ENABLE_FTM_RESPONDER,
6608  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AIRTIME_FAIRNESS,
6609  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AP_PMKSA_CACHING,
6610  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD, /* obsolete */
6611  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID,
6612  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_STA_TX_PWR,
6613  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD,
6614  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD,
6615  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AQL,
6616  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION,
6617  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH,
6618  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROTECTED_TWT,
6619  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DEL_IBSS_STA,
6620  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MULTICAST_REGISTRATIONS,
6621  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION_CLIENT,
6622  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ,
6623  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211_TX_STATUS,
6624  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OPERATING_CHANNEL_VALIDATION,
6625  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_AP_PSK,
6626  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD_AP,
6627  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_DISCOVERY,
6628  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP,
6629  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HE,
6630  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_LTF,
6631  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_RTT,
6632  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROT_RANGE_NEGO_AND_MEASURE,
6633  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_COLOR,
6634  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_CRYPTO_OFFLOAD,
6635  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RADAR_BACKGROUND,
6636  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_POWERED_ADDR_CHANGE,
6637  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PUNCT,
6638  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_NAN,
6639  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AUTH_AND_DEAUTH_RANDOM_TA,
6640  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD,
6641  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD_AP,
6642  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_CONCURRENT,
6643  	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SPP_AMSDU_SUPPORT,
6644  
6645  	/* add new features before the definition below */
6646  	NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES,
6647  	MAX_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES = NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES - 1
6648  };
6649  
6650  /**
6651   * enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr - optional supported
6652   *	protocols for probe-response offloading by the driver/FW.
6653   *	To be used with the %NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD attribute.
6654   *	Each enum value represents a bit in the bitmap of supported
6655   *	protocols. Typically a subset of probe-requests belonging to a
6656   *	supported protocol will be excluded from offload and uploaded
6657   *	to the host.
6658   *
6659   * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS: Support for WPS ver. 1
6660   * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS2: Support for WPS ver. 2
6661   * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_P2P: Support for P2P
6662   * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_80211U: Support for 802.11u
6663   */
6664  enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr {
6665  	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS =	1<<0,
6666  	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS2 =	1<<1,
6667  	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_P2P =	1<<2,
6668  	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_80211U =	1<<3,
6669  };
6670  
6671  /**
6672   * enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason - connection request failed reasons
6673   * @NL80211_CONN_FAIL_MAX_CLIENTS: Maximum number of clients that can be
6674   *	handled by the AP is reached.
6675   * @NL80211_CONN_FAIL_BLOCKED_CLIENT: Connection request is rejected due to ACL.
6676   */
6677  enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason {
6678  	NL80211_CONN_FAIL_MAX_CLIENTS,
6679  	NL80211_CONN_FAIL_BLOCKED_CLIENT,
6680  };
6681  
6682  /**
6683   * enum nl80211_timeout_reason - timeout reasons
6684   *
6685   * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED: Timeout reason unspecified.
6686   * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_SCAN: Scan (AP discovery) timed out.
6687   * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_AUTH: Authentication timed out.
6688   * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_ASSOC: Association timed out.
6689   */
6690  enum nl80211_timeout_reason {
6691  	NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED,
6692  	NL80211_TIMEOUT_SCAN,
6693  	NL80211_TIMEOUT_AUTH,
6694  	NL80211_TIMEOUT_ASSOC,
6695  };
6696  
6697  /**
6698   * enum nl80211_scan_flags -  scan request control flags
6699   *
6700   * Scan request control flags are used to control the handling
6701   * of NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN and NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN
6702   * requests.
6703   *
6704   * NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN, NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER, and
6705   * NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY flags are exclusive of each other, i.e., only
6706   * one of them can be used in the request.
6707   *
6708   * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_PRIORITY: scan request has low priority
6709   * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FLUSH: flush cache before scanning
6710   * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_AP: force a scan even if the interface is configured
6711   *	as AP and the beaconing has already been configured. This attribute is
6712   *	dangerous because will destroy stations performance as a lot of frames
6713   *	will be lost while scanning off-channel, therefore it must be used only
6714   *	when really needed
6715   * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR: use a random MAC address for this scan (or
6716   *	for scheduled scan: a different one for every scan iteration). When the
6717   *	flag is set, depending on device capabilities the @NL80211_ATTR_MAC and
6718   *	@NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK attributes may also be given in which case only
6719   *	the masked bits will be preserved from the MAC address and the remainder
6720   *	randomised. If the attributes are not given full randomisation (46 bits,
6721   *	locally administered 1, multicast 0) is assumed.
6722   *	This flag must not be requested when the feature isn't supported, check
6723   *	the nl80211 feature flags for the device.
6724   * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME: fill the dwell time in the FILS
6725   *	request parameters IE in the probe request
6726   * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: accept broadcast probe responses
6727   * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE: send probe request frames at
6728   *	rate of at least 5.5M. In case non-OCE AP is discovered in the channel,
6729   *	only the first probe req in the channel will be sent in high rate.
6730   * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION: allow probe request
6731   *	tx deferral (dot11FILSProbeDelay shall be set to 15ms)
6732   *	and suppression (if it has received a broadcast Probe Response frame,
6733   *	Beacon frame or FILS Discovery frame from an AP that the STA considers
6734   *	a suitable candidate for (re-)association - suitable in terms of
6735   *	SSID and/or RSSI.
6736   * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN: Span corresponds to the total time taken to
6737   *	accomplish the scan. Thus, this flag intends the driver to perform the
6738   *	scan request with lesser span/duration. It is specific to the driver
6739   *	implementations on how this is accomplished. Scan accuracy may get
6740   *	impacted with this flag.
6741   * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER: This flag intends the scan attempts to consume
6742   *	optimal possible power. Drivers can resort to their specific means to
6743   *	optimize the power. Scan accuracy may get impacted with this flag.
6744   * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY: Accuracy here intends to the extent of scan
6745   *	results obtained. Thus HIGH_ACCURACY scan flag aims to get maximum
6746   *	possible scan results. This flag hints the driver to use the best
6747   *	possible scan configuration to improve the accuracy in scanning.
6748   *	Latency and power use may get impacted with this flag.
6749   * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN: randomize the sequence number in probe
6750   *	request frames from this scan to avoid correlation/tracking being
6751   *	possible.
6752   * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT: minimize probe request content to
6753   *	only have supported rates and no additional capabilities (unless
6754   *	added by userspace explicitly.)
6755   * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FREQ_KHZ: report scan results with
6756   *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ. This also means
6757   *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES will not be included.
6758   * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_COLOCATED_6GHZ: scan for collocated APs reported by
6759   *	2.4/5 GHz APs. When the flag is set, the scan logic will use the
6760   *	information from the RNR element found in beacons/probe responses
6761   *	received on the 2.4/5 GHz channels to actively scan only the 6GHz
6762   *	channels on which APs are expected to be found. Note that when not set,
6763   *	the scan logic would scan all 6GHz channels, but since transmission of
6764   *	probe requests on non-PSC channels is limited, it is highly likely that
6765   *	these channels would passively be scanned. Also note that when the flag
6766   *	is set, in addition to the colocated APs, PSC channels would also be
6767   *	scanned if the user space has asked for it.
6768   */
6769  enum nl80211_scan_flags {
6770  	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_PRIORITY				= 1<<0,
6771  	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FLUSH					= 1<<1,
6772  	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_AP					= 1<<2,
6773  	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR				= 1<<3,
6774  	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME			= 1<<4,
6775  	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP		= 1<<5,
6776  	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE		= 1<<6,
6777  	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION	= 1<<7,
6778  	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN				= 1<<8,
6779  	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER				= 1<<9,
6780  	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY				= 1<<10,
6781  	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN				= 1<<11,
6782  	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT			= 1<<12,
6783  	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FREQ_KHZ				= 1<<13,
6784  	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_COLOCATED_6GHZ			= 1<<14,
6785  };
6786  
6787  /**
6788   * enum nl80211_acl_policy - access control policy
6789   *
6790   * Access control policy is applied on a MAC list set by
6791   * %NL80211_CMD_START_AP and %NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL, to
6792   * be used with %NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY.
6793   *
6794   * @NL80211_ACL_POLICY_ACCEPT_UNLESS_LISTED: Deny stations which are
6795   *	listed in ACL, i.e. allow all the stations which are not listed
6796   *	in ACL to authenticate.
6797   * @NL80211_ACL_POLICY_DENY_UNLESS_LISTED: Allow the stations which are listed
6798   *	in ACL, i.e. deny all the stations which are not listed in ACL.
6799   */
6800  enum nl80211_acl_policy {
6801  	NL80211_ACL_POLICY_ACCEPT_UNLESS_LISTED,
6802  	NL80211_ACL_POLICY_DENY_UNLESS_LISTED,
6803  };
6804  
6805  /**
6806   * enum nl80211_smps_mode - SMPS mode
6807   *
6808   * Requested SMPS mode (for AP mode)
6809   *
6810   * @NL80211_SMPS_OFF: SMPS off (use all antennas).
6811   * @NL80211_SMPS_STATIC: static SMPS (use a single antenna)
6812   * @NL80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic smps (start with a single antenna and
6813   *	turn on other antennas after CTS/RTS).
6814   * @__NL80211_SMPS_AFTER_LAST: internal
6815   * @NL80211_SMPS_MAX: highest used enumeration
6816   */
6817  enum nl80211_smps_mode {
6818  	NL80211_SMPS_OFF,
6819  	NL80211_SMPS_STATIC,
6820  	NL80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
6821  
6822  	__NL80211_SMPS_AFTER_LAST,
6823  	NL80211_SMPS_MAX = __NL80211_SMPS_AFTER_LAST - 1
6824  };
6825  
6826  /**
6827   * enum nl80211_radar_event - type of radar event for DFS operation
6828   *
6829   * Type of event to be used with NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT to inform userspace
6830   * about detected radars or success of the channel available check (CAC)
6831   *
6832   * @NL80211_RADAR_DETECTED: A radar pattern has been detected. The channel is
6833   *	now unusable.
6834   * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_FINISHED: Channel Availability Check has been finished,
6835   *	the channel is now available.
6836   * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_ABORTED: Channel Availability Check has been aborted, no
6837   *	change to the channel status.
6838   * @NL80211_RADAR_NOP_FINISHED: The Non-Occupancy Period for this channel is
6839   *	over, channel becomes usable.
6840   * @NL80211_RADAR_PRE_CAC_EXPIRED: Channel Availability Check done on this
6841   *	non-operating channel is expired and no longer valid. New CAC must
6842   *	be done on this channel before starting the operation. This is not
6843   *	applicable for ETSI dfs domain where pre-CAC is valid for ever.
6844   * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_STARTED: Channel Availability Check has been started,
6845   *	should be generated by HW if NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD is enabled.
6846   */
6847  enum nl80211_radar_event {
6848  	NL80211_RADAR_DETECTED,
6849  	NL80211_RADAR_CAC_FINISHED,
6850  	NL80211_RADAR_CAC_ABORTED,
6851  	NL80211_RADAR_NOP_FINISHED,
6852  	NL80211_RADAR_PRE_CAC_EXPIRED,
6853  	NL80211_RADAR_CAC_STARTED,
6854  };
6855  
6856  /**
6857   * enum nl80211_dfs_state - DFS states for channels
6858   *
6859   * Channel states used by the DFS code.
6860   *
6861   * @NL80211_DFS_USABLE: The channel can be used, but channel availability
6862   *	check (CAC) must be performed before using it for AP or IBSS.
6863   * @NL80211_DFS_UNAVAILABLE: A radar has been detected on this channel, it
6864   *	is therefore marked as not available.
6865   * @NL80211_DFS_AVAILABLE: The channel has been CAC checked and is available.
6866   */
6867  enum nl80211_dfs_state {
6868  	NL80211_DFS_USABLE,
6869  	NL80211_DFS_UNAVAILABLE,
6870  	NL80211_DFS_AVAILABLE,
6871  };
6872  
6873  /**
6874   * enum nl80211_protocol_features - nl80211 protocol features
6875   * @NL80211_PROTOCOL_FEATURE_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP: nl80211 supports splitting
6876   *	wiphy dumps (if requested by the application with the attribute
6877   *	%NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP. Also supported is filtering the
6878   *	wiphy dump by %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY, %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX or
6879   *	%NL80211_ATTR_WDEV.
6880   */
6881  enum nl80211_protocol_features {
6882  	NL80211_PROTOCOL_FEATURE_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP =	1 << 0,
6883  };
6884  
6885  /**
6886   * enum nl80211_crit_proto_id - nl80211 critical protocol identifiers
6887   *
6888   * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_UNSPEC: protocol unspecified.
6889   * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_DHCP: BOOTP or DHCPv6 protocol.
6890   * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_EAPOL: EAPOL protocol.
6891   * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_APIPA: APIPA protocol.
6892   * @NUM_NL80211_CRIT_PROTO: must be kept last.
6893   */
6894  enum nl80211_crit_proto_id {
6895  	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_UNSPEC,
6896  	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_DHCP,
6897  	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_EAPOL,
6898  	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_APIPA,
6899  	/* add other protocols before this one */
6900  	NUM_NL80211_CRIT_PROTO
6901  };
6902  
6903  /* maximum duration for critical protocol measures */
6904  #define NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_MAX_DURATION		5000 /* msec */
6905  
6906  /**
6907   * enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags - flags for received management frame.
6908   *
6909   * Used by cfg80211_rx_mgmt()
6910   *
6911   * @NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_ANSWERED: frame was answered by device/driver.
6912   * @NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_EXTERNAL_AUTH: Host driver intends to offload
6913   *	the authentication. Exclusively defined for host drivers that
6914   *	advertises the SME functionality but would like the userspace
6915   *	to handle certain authentication algorithms (e.g. SAE).
6916   */
6917  enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags {
6918  	NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_ANSWERED = 1 << 0,
6919  	NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_EXTERNAL_AUTH = 1 << 1,
6920  };
6921  
6922  /*
6923   * If this flag is unset, the lower 24 bits are an OUI, if set
6924   * a Linux nl80211 vendor ID is used (no such IDs are allocated
6925   * yet, so that's not valid so far)
6926   */
6927  #define NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX	0x80000000
6928  
6929  /**
6930   * struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info - vendor command data
6931   * @vendor_id: If the %NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX flag is clear, then the
6932   *	value is a 24-bit OUI; if it is set then a separately allocated ID
6933   *	may be used, but no such IDs are allocated yet. New IDs should be
6934   *	added to this file when needed.
6935   * @subcmd: sub-command ID for the command
6936   */
6937  struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info {
6938  	__u32 vendor_id;
6939  	__u32 subcmd;
6940  };
6941  
6942  /**
6943   * enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability - TDLS peer flags.
6944   *
6945   * Used by tdls_mgmt() to determine which conditional elements need
6946   * to be added to TDLS Setup frames.
6947   *
6948   * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HT: TDLS peer is HT capable.
6949   * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_VHT: TDLS peer is VHT capable.
6950   * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_WMM: TDLS peer is WMM capable.
6951   * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HE: TDLS peer is HE capable.
6952   */
6953  enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability {
6954  	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HT = 1<<0,
6955  	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_VHT = 1<<1,
6956  	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_WMM = 1<<2,
6957  	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HE = 1<<3,
6958  };
6959  
6960  /**
6961   * enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan - scanning plan for scheduled scan
6962   * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
6963   * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL: interval between scan iterations. In
6964   *	seconds (u32).
6965   * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS: number of scan iterations in this
6966   *	scan plan (u32). The last scan plan must not specify this attribute
6967   *	because it will run infinitely. A value of zero is invalid as it will
6968   *	make the scan plan meaningless.
6969   * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_MAX: highest scheduled scan plan attribute number
6970   *	currently defined
6971   * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST: internal use
6972   */
6973  enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan {
6974  	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INVALID,
6975  	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL,
6976  	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS,
6977  
6978  	/* keep last */
6979  	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST,
6980  	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_MAX =
6981  		__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST - 1
6982  };
6983  
6984  /**
6985   * struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust - RSSI adjustment parameters.
6986   *
6987   * @band: band of BSS that must match for RSSI value adjustment. The value
6988   *	of this field is according to &enum nl80211_band.
6989   * @delta: value used to adjust the RSSI value of matching BSS in dB.
6990   */
6991  struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust {
6992  	__u8 band;
6993  	__s8 delta;
6994  } __attribute__((packed));
6995  
6996  /**
6997   * enum nl80211_bss_select_attr - attributes for bss selection.
6998   *
6999   * @__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_INVALID: reserved.
7000   * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI: Flag indicating only RSSI-based BSS selection
7001   *	is requested.
7002   * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF: attribute indicating BSS
7003   *	selection should be done such that the specified band is preferred.
7004   *	When there are multiple BSS-es in the preferred band, the driver
7005   *	shall use RSSI-based BSS selection as a second step. The value of
7006   *	this attribute is according to &enum nl80211_band (u32).
7007   * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for
7008   *	BSS-es in the specified band is to be adjusted before doing
7009   *	RSSI-based BSS selection. The attribute value is a packed structure
7010   *	value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust.
7011   * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_MAX: highest bss select attribute number.
7012   * @__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use.
7013   *
7014   * One and only one of these attributes are found within %NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT
7015   * for %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. It specifies the required BSS selection behaviour
7016   * which the driver shall use.
7017   */
7018  enum nl80211_bss_select_attr {
7019  	__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_INVALID,
7020  	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI,
7021  	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF,
7022  	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST,
7023  
7024  	/* keep last */
7025  	__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
7026  	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
7027  };
7028  
7029  /**
7030   * enum nl80211_nan_function_type - NAN function type
7031   *
7032   * Defines the function type of a NAN function
7033   *
7034   * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH: function is publish
7035   * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE: function is subscribe
7036   * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP: function is follow-up
7037   * @__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE_AFTER_LAST: internal use
7038   * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_MAX_TYPE: internal use
7039   */
7040  enum nl80211_nan_function_type {
7041  	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH,
7042  	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE,
7043  	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP,
7044  
7045  	/* keep last */
7046  	__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE_AFTER_LAST,
7047  	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_MAX_TYPE = __NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE_AFTER_LAST - 1,
7048  };
7049  
7050  /**
7051   * enum nl80211_nan_publish_type - NAN publish tx type
7052   *
7053   * Defines how to send publish Service Discovery Frames
7054   *
7055   * @NL80211_NAN_SOLICITED_PUBLISH: publish function is solicited
7056   * @NL80211_NAN_UNSOLICITED_PUBLISH: publish function is unsolicited
7057   */
7058  enum nl80211_nan_publish_type {
7059  	NL80211_NAN_SOLICITED_PUBLISH = 1 << 0,
7060  	NL80211_NAN_UNSOLICITED_PUBLISH = 1 << 1,
7061  };
7062  
7063  /**
7064   * enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason - NAN functions termination reason
7065   *
7066   * Defines termination reasons of a NAN function
7067   *
7068   * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST: requested by user
7069   * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_TTL_EXPIRED: timeout
7070   * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_ERROR: errored
7071   */
7072  enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason {
7073  	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST,
7074  	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_TTL_EXPIRED,
7075  	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_ERROR,
7076  };
7077  
7078  #define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN 6
7079  #define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_SPEC_INFO_MAX_LEN 0xff
7080  #define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF_MAX_LEN 0xff
7081  
7082  /**
7083   * enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes - NAN function attributes
7084   * @__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INVALID: invalid
7085   * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type (u8).
7086   * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID: 6 bytes of the service ID hash as
7087   *	specified in NAN spec. This is a binary attribute.
7088   * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_TYPE: relevant if the function's type is
7089   *	publish. Defines the transmission type for the publish Service Discovery
7090   *	Frame, see &enum nl80211_nan_publish_type. Its type is u8.
7091   * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_BCAST: relevant if the function is a solicited
7092   *	publish. Should the solicited publish Service Discovery Frame be sent to
7093   *	the NAN Broadcast address. This is a flag.
7094   * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE_ACTIVE: relevant if the function's type is
7095   *	subscribe. Is the subscribe active. This is a flag.
7096   * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_ID: relevant if the function's type is follow up.
7097   *	The instance ID for the follow up Service Discovery Frame. This is u8.
7098   * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_REQ_ID: relevant if the function's type
7099   *	is follow up. This is a u8.
7100   *	The requester instance ID for the follow up Service Discovery Frame.
7101   * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_DEST: the MAC address of the recipient of the
7102   *	follow up Service Discovery Frame. This is a binary attribute.
7103   * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_CLOSE_RANGE: is this function limited for devices in a
7104   *	close range. The range itself (RSSI) is defined by the device.
7105   *	This is a flag.
7106   * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TTL: strictly positive number of DWs this function should
7107   *	stay active. If not present infinite TTL is assumed. This is a u32.
7108   * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_INFO: array of bytes describing the service
7109   *	specific info. This is a binary attribute.
7110   * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF: Service Receive Filter. This is a nested attribute.
7111   *	See &enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes.
7112   * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_RX_MATCH_FILTER: Receive Matching filter. This is a nested
7113   *	attribute. It is a list of binary values.
7114   * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TX_MATCH_FILTER: Transmit Matching filter. This is a
7115   *	nested attribute. It is a list of binary values.
7116   * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INSTANCE_ID: The instance ID of the function.
7117   *	Its type is u8 and it cannot be 0.
7118   * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON: NAN function termination reason.
7119   *	See &enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason.
7120   *
7121   * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR: internal
7122   * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN function attribute
7123   */
7124  enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes {
7125  	__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INVALID,
7126  	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE,
7127  	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID,
7128  	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_TYPE,
7129  	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_BCAST,
7130  	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE_ACTIVE,
7131  	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_ID,
7132  	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_REQ_ID,
7133  	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_DEST,
7134  	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_CLOSE_RANGE,
7135  	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TTL,
7136  	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_INFO,
7137  	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF,
7138  	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_RX_MATCH_FILTER,
7139  	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TX_MATCH_FILTER,
7140  	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INSTANCE_ID,
7141  	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON,
7142  
7143  	/* keep last */
7144  	NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR,
7145  	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR - 1
7146  };
7147  
7148  /**
7149   * enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes - NAN Service Response filter attributes
7150   * @__NL80211_NAN_SRF_INVALID: invalid
7151   * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_INCLUDE: present if the include bit of the SRF set.
7152   *	This is a flag.
7153   * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF: Bloom Filter. Present if and only if
7154   *	%NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS isn't present. This attribute is binary.
7155   * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF_IDX: index of the Bloom Filter. Mandatory if
7156   *	%NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF is present. This is a u8.
7157   * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS: list of MAC addresses for the SRF. Present if
7158   *	and only if %NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF isn't present. This is a nested
7159   *	attribute. Each nested attribute is a MAC address.
7160   * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR: internal
7161   * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN SRF attribute
7162   */
7163  enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes {
7164  	__NL80211_NAN_SRF_INVALID,
7165  	NL80211_NAN_SRF_INCLUDE,
7166  	NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF,
7167  	NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF_IDX,
7168  	NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS,
7169  
7170  	/* keep last */
7171  	NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR,
7172  	NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR - 1,
7173  };
7174  
7175  /**
7176   * enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes - NAN match attributes
7177   * @__NL80211_NAN_MATCH_INVALID: invalid
7178   * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_LOCAL: the local function that had the
7179   *	match. This is a nested attribute.
7180   *	See &enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes.
7181   * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_PEER: the peer function
7182   *	that caused the match. This is a nested attribute.
7183   *	See &enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes.
7184   *
7185   * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR: internal
7186   * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN match attribute
7187   */
7188  enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes {
7189  	__NL80211_NAN_MATCH_INVALID,
7190  	NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_LOCAL,
7191  	NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_PEER,
7192  
7193  	/* keep last */
7194  	NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR,
7195  	NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR - 1
7196  };
7197  
7198  /**
7199   * enum nl80211_external_auth_action - Action to perform with external
7200   *     authentication request. Used by NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION.
7201   * @NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_START: Start the authentication.
7202   * @NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ABORT: Abort the ongoing authentication.
7203   */
7204  enum nl80211_external_auth_action {
7205  	NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_START,
7206  	NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ABORT,
7207  };
7208  
7209  /**
7210   * enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attributes - fine timing measurement
7211   *	responder attributes
7212   * @__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7213   * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_ENABLED: FTM responder is enabled
7214   * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI: The content of Measurement Report Element
7215   *	(9.4.2.22 in 802.11-2016) with type 8 - LCI (9.4.2.22.10),
7216   *	i.e. starting with the measurement token
7217   * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC: The content of Measurement Report Element
7218   *	(9.4.2.22 in 802.11-2016) with type 11 - Civic (Section 9.4.2.22.13),
7219   *	i.e. starting with the measurement token
7220   * @__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7221   * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest FTM responder attribute.
7222   */
7223  enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attributes {
7224  	__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
7225  
7226  	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_ENABLED,
7227  	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI,
7228  	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC,
7229  
7230  	/* keep last */
7231  	__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST,
7232  	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7233  };
7234  
7235  /*
7236   * enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics
7237   *
7238   * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS
7239   * when getting FTM responder statistics.
7240   *
7241   * @__NL80211_FTM_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
7242   * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_SUCCESS_NUM: number of FTM sessions in which all frames
7243   *	were ssfully answered (u32)
7244   * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_PARTIAL_NUM: number of FTM sessions in which part of the
7245   *	frames were successfully answered (u32)
7246   * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_FAILED_NUM: number of failed FTM sessions (u32)
7247   * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_ASAP_NUM: number of ASAP sessions (u32)
7248   * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_NON_ASAP_NUM: number of non-ASAP sessions (u32)
7249   * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_TOTAL_DURATION_MSEC: total sessions durations - gives an
7250   *	indication of how much time the responder was busy (u64, msec)
7251   * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_UNKNOWN_TRIGGERS_NUM: number of unknown FTM triggers -
7252   *	triggers from initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation
7253   *	phase with the responder (u32)
7254   * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_RESCHEDULE_REQUESTS_NUM: number of FTM reschedule requests
7255   *	- initiator asks for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled
7256   *	FTM slot (u32)
7257   * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_OUT_OF_WINDOW_TRIGGERS_NUM: number of FTM triggers out of
7258   *	scheduled window (u32)
7259   * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_PAD: used for padding, ignore
7260   * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal
7261   * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_MAX: highest possible FTM responder stats attribute
7262   */
7263  enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats {
7264  	__NL80211_FTM_STATS_INVALID,
7265  	NL80211_FTM_STATS_SUCCESS_NUM,
7266  	NL80211_FTM_STATS_PARTIAL_NUM,
7267  	NL80211_FTM_STATS_FAILED_NUM,
7268  	NL80211_FTM_STATS_ASAP_NUM,
7269  	NL80211_FTM_STATS_NON_ASAP_NUM,
7270  	NL80211_FTM_STATS_TOTAL_DURATION_MSEC,
7271  	NL80211_FTM_STATS_UNKNOWN_TRIGGERS_NUM,
7272  	NL80211_FTM_STATS_RESCHEDULE_REQUESTS_NUM,
7273  	NL80211_FTM_STATS_OUT_OF_WINDOW_TRIGGERS_NUM,
7274  	NL80211_FTM_STATS_PAD,
7275  
7276  	/* keep last */
7277  	__NL80211_FTM_STATS_AFTER_LAST,
7278  	NL80211_FTM_STATS_MAX = __NL80211_FTM_STATS_AFTER_LAST - 1
7279  };
7280  
7281  /**
7282   * enum nl80211_preamble - frame preamble types
7283   * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_LEGACY: legacy (HR/DSSS, OFDM, ERP PHY) preamble
7284   * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_HT: HT preamble
7285   * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_VHT: VHT preamble
7286   * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_DMG: DMG preamble
7287   * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_HE: HE preamble
7288   */
7289  enum nl80211_preamble {
7290  	NL80211_PREAMBLE_LEGACY,
7291  	NL80211_PREAMBLE_HT,
7292  	NL80211_PREAMBLE_VHT,
7293  	NL80211_PREAMBLE_DMG,
7294  	NL80211_PREAMBLE_HE,
7295  };
7296  
7297  /**
7298   * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type - peer measurement types
7299   * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_INVALID: invalid/unused, needed as we use
7300   *	these numbers also for attributes
7301   *
7302   * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_FTM: flight time measurement
7303   *
7304   * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES: internal
7305   * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_MAX: highest type number
7306   */
7307  enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type {
7308  	NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_INVALID,
7309  
7310  	NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_FTM,
7311  
7312  	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES,
7313  	NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES - 1
7314  };
7315  
7316  /**
7317   * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status - peer measurement status
7318   * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_SUCCESS: measurement completed successfully
7319   * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_REFUSED: measurement was locally refused
7320   * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_TIMEOUT: measurement timed out
7321   * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE: measurement failed, a type-dependent
7322   *	reason may be available in the response data
7323   */
7324  enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status {
7325  	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_SUCCESS,
7326  	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_REFUSED,
7327  	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_TIMEOUT,
7328  	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE,
7329  };
7330  
7331  /**
7332   * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req - peer measurement request attributes
7333   * @__NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7334   *
7335   * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_DATA: This is a nested attribute with measurement
7336   *	type-specific request data inside. The attributes used are from the
7337   *	enums named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_req.
7338   * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_GET_AP_TSF: include AP TSF timestamp, if supported
7339   *	(flag attribute)
7340   *
7341   * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS: internal
7342   * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7343   */
7344  enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req {
7345  	__NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_INVALID,
7346  
7347  	NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_DATA,
7348  	NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_GET_AP_TSF,
7349  
7350  	/* keep last */
7351  	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS,
7352  	NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS - 1
7353  };
7354  
7355  /**
7356   * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp - peer measurement response attributes
7357   * @__NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7358   *
7359   * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_DATA: This is a nested attribute with measurement
7360   *	type-specific results inside. The attributes used are from the enums
7361   *	named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_resp.
7362   * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_STATUS: u32 value with the measurement status
7363   *	(using values from &enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status.)
7364   * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_HOST_TIME: host time (%CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the
7365   *	result was measured; this value is not expected to be accurate to
7366   *	more than 20ms. (u64, nanoseconds)
7367   * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_AP_TSF: TSF of the AP that the interface
7368   *	doing the measurement is connected to when the result was measured.
7369   *	This shall be accurately reported if supported and requested
7370   *	(u64, usec)
7371   * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_FINAL: If results are sent to the host partially
7372   *	(*e.g. with FTM per-burst data) this flag will be cleared on all but
7373   *	the last result; if all results are combined it's set on the single
7374   *	result.
7375   * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_PAD: padding for 64-bit attributes, ignore
7376   *
7377   * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS: internal
7378   * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7379   */
7380  enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp {
7381  	__NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
7382  
7383  	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_DATA,
7384  	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_STATUS,
7385  	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_HOST_TIME,
7386  	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_AP_TSF,
7387  	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_FINAL,
7388  	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_PAD,
7389  
7390  	/* keep last */
7391  	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS,
7392  	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS - 1
7393  };
7394  
7395  /**
7396   * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs - peer attributes for measurement
7397   * @__NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7398   *
7399   * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_ADDR: peer's MAC address
7400   * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_CHAN: channel definition, nested, using top-level
7401   *	attributes like %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ etc.
7402   * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_REQ: This is a nested attribute indexed by
7403   *	measurement type, with attributes from the
7404   *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req inside.
7405   * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_RESP: This is a nested attribute indexed by
7406   *	measurement type, with attributes from the
7407   *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp inside.
7408   *
7409   * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS: internal
7410   * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7411   */
7412  enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs {
7413  	__NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_INVALID,
7414  
7415  	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_ADDR,
7416  	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_CHAN,
7417  	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_REQ,
7418  	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_RESP,
7419  
7420  	/* keep last */
7421  	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS,
7422  	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS - 1,
7423  };
7424  
7425  /**
7426   * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs - peer measurement attributes
7427   * @__NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7428   *
7429   * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX_PEERS: u32 attribute used for capability
7430   *	advertisement only, indicates the maximum number of peers
7431   *	measurements can be done with in a single request
7432   * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_REPORT_AP_TSF: flag attribute in capability
7433   *	indicating that the connected AP's TSF can be reported in
7434   *	measurement results
7435   * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_RANDOMIZE_MAC_ADDR: flag attribute in capability
7436   *	indicating that MAC address randomization is supported.
7437   * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_TYPE_CAPA: capabilities reported by the device,
7438   *	this contains a nesting indexed by measurement type, and
7439   *	type-specific capabilities inside, which are from the enums
7440   *	named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_capa.
7441   * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_PEERS: nested attribute, the nesting index is
7442   *	meaningless, just a list of peers to measure with, with the
7443   *	sub-attributes taken from
7444   *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs.
7445   *
7446   * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR: internal
7447   * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7448   */
7449  enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs {
7450  	__NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_INVALID,
7451  
7452  	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX_PEERS,
7453  	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_REPORT_AP_TSF,
7454  	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_RANDOMIZE_MAC_ADDR,
7455  	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_TYPE_CAPA,
7456  	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_PEERS,
7457  
7458  	/* keep last */
7459  	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR,
7460  	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR - 1
7461  };
7462  
7463  /**
7464   * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_capa - FTM capabilities
7465   * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7466   *
7467   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_ASAP: flag attribute indicating ASAP mode
7468   *	is supported
7469   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_ASAP: flag attribute indicating non-ASAP
7470   *	mode is supported
7471   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_LCI: flag attribute indicating if LCI
7472   *	data can be requested during the measurement
7473   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_CIVICLOC: flag attribute indicating if civic
7474   *	location data can be requested during the measurement
7475   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_PREAMBLES: u32 bitmap attribute of bits
7476   *	from &enum nl80211_preamble.
7477   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_BANDWIDTHS: bitmap of values from
7478   *	&enum nl80211_chan_width indicating the supported channel
7479   *	bandwidths for FTM. Note that a higher channel bandwidth may be
7480   *	configured to allow for other measurements types with different
7481   *	bandwidth requirement in the same measurement.
7482   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_BURSTS_EXPONENT: u32 attribute indicating
7483   *	the maximum bursts exponent that can be used (if not present anything
7484   *	is valid)
7485   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_FTMS_PER_BURST: u32 attribute indicating
7486   *	the maximum FTMs per burst (if not present anything is valid)
7487   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED: flag attribute indicating if
7488   *	trigger based ranging measurement is supported
7489   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED: flag attribute indicating
7490   *	if non-trigger-based ranging measurement is supported
7491   *
7492   * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR: internal
7493   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7494   */
7495  enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_capa {
7496  	__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_INVALID,
7497  
7498  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_ASAP,
7499  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_ASAP,
7500  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_LCI,
7501  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_CIVICLOC,
7502  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_PREAMBLES,
7503  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_BANDWIDTHS,
7504  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_BURSTS_EXPONENT,
7505  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_FTMS_PER_BURST,
7506  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED,
7507  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED,
7508  
7509  	/* keep last */
7510  	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR,
7511  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR - 1
7512  };
7513  
7514  /**
7515   * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_req - FTM request attributes
7516   * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7517   *
7518   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_ASAP: ASAP mode requested (flag)
7519   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_PREAMBLE: preamble type (see
7520   *	&enum nl80211_preamble), optional for DMG (u32)
7521   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP: number of bursts exponent as in
7522   *	802.11-2016 9.4.2.168 "Fine Timing Measurement Parameters element"
7523   *	(u8, 0-15, optional with default 15 i.e. "no preference")
7524   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_PERIOD: interval between bursts in units
7525   *	of 100ms (u16, optional with default 0)
7526   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_DURATION: burst duration, as in 802.11-2016
7527   *	Table 9-257 "Burst Duration field encoding" (u8, 0-15, optional with
7528   *	default 15 i.e. "no preference")
7529   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST: number of successful FTM frames
7530   *	requested per burst
7531   *	(u8, 0-31, optional with default 0 i.e. "no preference")
7532   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_RETRIES: number of FTMR frame retries
7533   *	(u8, default 3)
7534   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_LCI: request LCI data (flag)
7535   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_CIVICLOC: request civic location data
7536   *	(flag)
7537   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED: request trigger based ranging
7538   *	measurement (flag).
7539   *	This attribute and %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED are
7540   *	mutually exclusive.
7541   *      if neither %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED nor
7542   *	%NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED is set, EDCA based
7543   *	ranging will be used.
7544   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED: request non-trigger-based
7545   *	ranging measurement (flag)
7546   *	This attribute and %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED are
7547   *	mutually exclusive.
7548   *      if neither %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED nor
7549   *	%NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED is set, EDCA based
7550   *	ranging will be used.
7551   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_LMR_FEEDBACK: negotiate for LMR feedback. Only
7552   *	valid if either %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED or
7553   *	%NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED is set.
7554   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BSS_COLOR: optional. The BSS color of the
7555   *	responder. Only valid if %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED
7556   *	or %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED is set.
7557   *
7558   * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR: internal
7559   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7560   */
7561  enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_req {
7562  	__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_INVALID,
7563  
7564  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_ASAP,
7565  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_PREAMBLE,
7566  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP,
7567  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_PERIOD,
7568  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_DURATION,
7569  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST,
7570  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_RETRIES,
7571  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_LCI,
7572  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_CIVICLOC,
7573  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED,
7574  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED,
7575  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_LMR_FEEDBACK,
7576  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BSS_COLOR,
7577  
7578  	/* keep last */
7579  	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR,
7580  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR - 1
7581  };
7582  
7583  /**
7584   * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons - FTM failure reasons
7585   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_UNSPECIFIED: unspecified failure, not used
7586   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_NO_RESPONSE: no response from the FTM responder
7587   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_REJECTED: FTM responder rejected measurement
7588   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_WRONG_CHANNEL: we already know the peer is
7589   *	on a different channel, so can't measure (if we didn't know, we'd
7590   *	try and get no response)
7591   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_NOT_CAPABLE: peer can't actually do FTM
7592   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_INVALID_TIMESTAMP: invalid T1/T4 timestamps
7593   *	received
7594   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY: peer reports busy, you may retry
7595   *	later (see %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME)
7596   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_BAD_CHANGED_PARAMS: parameters were changed
7597   *	by the peer and are no longer supported
7598   */
7599  enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons {
7600  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_UNSPECIFIED,
7601  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_NO_RESPONSE,
7602  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_REJECTED,
7603  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_WRONG_CHANNEL,
7604  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_NOT_CAPABLE,
7605  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_INVALID_TIMESTAMP,
7606  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY,
7607  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_BAD_CHANGED_PARAMS,
7608  };
7609  
7610  /**
7611   * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_resp - FTM response attributes
7612   * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7613   *
7614   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FAIL_REASON: FTM-specific failure reason
7615   *	(u32, optional)
7616   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_INDEX: optional, if bursts are reported
7617   *	as separate results then it will be the burst index 0...(N-1) and
7618   *	the top level will indicate partial results (u32)
7619   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_ATTEMPTS: number of FTM Request frames
7620   *	transmitted (u32, optional)
7621   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_SUCCESSES: number of FTM Request frames
7622   *	that were acknowledged (u32, optional)
7623   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME: retry time received from the
7624   *	busy peer (u32, seconds)
7625   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP: actual number of bursts exponent
7626   *	used by the responder (similar to request, u8)
7627   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_DURATION: actual burst duration used by
7628   *	the responder (similar to request, u8)
7629   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST: actual FTMs per burst used
7630   *	by the responder (similar to request, u8)
7631   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_AVG: average RSSI across all FTM action
7632   *	frames (optional, s32, 1/2 dBm)
7633   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_SPREAD: RSSI spread across all FTM action
7634   *	frames (optional, s32, 1/2 dBm)
7635   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_TX_RATE: bitrate we used for the response to the
7636   *	FTM action frame (optional, nested, using &enum nl80211_rate_info
7637   *	attributes)
7638   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RX_RATE: bitrate the responder used for the FTM
7639   *	action frame (optional, nested, using &enum nl80211_rate_info attrs)
7640   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_AVG: average RTT (s64, picoseconds, optional
7641   *	but one of RTT/DIST must be present)
7642   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_VARIANCE: RTT variance (u64, ps^2, note that
7643   *	standard deviation is the square root of variance, optional)
7644   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_SPREAD: RTT spread (u64, picoseconds,
7645   *	optional)
7646   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_AVG: average distance (s64, mm, optional
7647   *	but one of RTT/DIST must be present)
7648   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_VARIANCE: distance variance (u64, mm^2, note
7649   *	that standard deviation is the square root of variance, optional)
7650   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_SPREAD: distance spread (u64, mm, optional)
7651   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI: LCI data from peer (binary, optional);
7652   *	this is the contents of the Measurement Report Element (802.11-2016
7653   *	9.4.2.22.1) starting with the Measurement Token, with Measurement
7654   *	Type 8.
7655   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC: civic location data from peer
7656   *	(binary, optional);
7657   *	this is the contents of the Measurement Report Element (802.11-2016
7658   *	9.4.2.22.1) starting with the Measurement Token, with Measurement
7659   *	Type 11.
7660   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_PAD: ignore, for u64/s64 padding only
7661   *
7662   * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR: internal
7663   * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7664   */
7665  enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_resp {
7666  	__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
7667  
7668  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FAIL_REASON,
7669  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_INDEX,
7670  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_ATTEMPTS,
7671  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_SUCCESSES,
7672  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME,
7673  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP,
7674  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_DURATION,
7675  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST,
7676  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_AVG,
7677  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_SPREAD,
7678  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_TX_RATE,
7679  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RX_RATE,
7680  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_AVG,
7681  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_VARIANCE,
7682  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_SPREAD,
7683  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_AVG,
7684  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_VARIANCE,
7685  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_SPREAD,
7686  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI,
7687  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC,
7688  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_PAD,
7689  
7690  	/* keep last */
7691  	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR,
7692  	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR - 1
7693  };
7694  
7695  /**
7696   * enum nl80211_obss_pd_attributes - OBSS packet detection attributes
7697   * @__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7698   *
7699   * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MIN_OFFSET: the OBSS PD minimum tx power offset.
7700   * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX_OFFSET: the OBSS PD maximum tx power offset.
7701   * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_NON_SRG_MAX_OFFSET: the non-SRG OBSS PD maximum
7702   *	tx power offset.
7703   * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_BSS_COLOR_BITMAP: bitmap that indicates the BSS color
7704   *	values used by members of the SRG.
7705   * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_PARTIAL_BSSID_BITMAP: bitmap that indicates the partial
7706   *	BSSID values used by members of the SRG.
7707   * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_SR_CTRL: The SR Control field of SRP element.
7708   *
7709   * @__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7710   * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX: highest OBSS PD attribute.
7711   */
7712  enum nl80211_obss_pd_attributes {
7713  	__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_INVALID,
7714  
7715  	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MIN_OFFSET,
7716  	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX_OFFSET,
7717  	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_NON_SRG_MAX_OFFSET,
7718  	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_BSS_COLOR_BITMAP,
7719  	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_PARTIAL_BSSID_BITMAP,
7720  	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_SR_CTRL,
7721  
7722  	/* keep last */
7723  	__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST,
7724  	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7725  };
7726  
7727  /**
7728   * enum nl80211_bss_color_attributes - BSS Color attributes
7729   * @__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7730   *
7731   * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_COLOR: the current BSS Color.
7732   * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_DISABLED: is BSS coloring disabled.
7733   * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_PARTIAL: the AID equation to be used..
7734   *
7735   * @__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7736   * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_MAX: highest BSS Color attribute.
7737   */
7738  enum nl80211_bss_color_attributes {
7739  	__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_INVALID,
7740  
7741  	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_COLOR,
7742  	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_DISABLED,
7743  	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_PARTIAL,
7744  
7745  	/* keep last */
7746  	__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST,
7747  	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7748  };
7749  
7750  /**
7751   * enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes - interface type AKM attributes
7752   * @__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7753   *
7754   * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing a flag
7755   *	attribute for each interface type that supports AKM suites specified in
7756   *	%NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES
7757   * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES: an array of u32. Used to indicate supported
7758   *	AKM suites for the specified interface types.
7759   *
7760   * @__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7761   * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_MAX: highest interface type AKM attribute.
7762   */
7763  enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes {
7764  	__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_INVALID,
7765  
7766  	NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_IFTYPES,
7767  	NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES,
7768  
7769  	/* keep last */
7770  	__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST,
7771  	NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7772  };
7773  
7774  /**
7775   * enum nl80211_fils_discovery_attributes - FILS discovery configuration
7776   * from IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
7777   *
7778   * @__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7779   *
7780   * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MIN: Minimum packet interval (u32, TU).
7781   *	Allowed range: 0..10000 (TU = Time Unit)
7782   * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MAX: Maximum packet interval (u32, TU).
7783   *	Allowed range: 0..10000 (TU = Time Unit). If set to 0, the feature is disabled.
7784   * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_TMPL: Template data for FILS discovery action
7785   *	frame including the headers.
7786   *
7787   * @__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7788   * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute
7789   */
7790  enum nl80211_fils_discovery_attributes {
7791  	__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INVALID,
7792  
7793  	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MIN,
7794  	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MAX,
7795  	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_TMPL,
7796  
7797  	/* keep last */
7798  	__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_LAST,
7799  	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_LAST - 1
7800  };
7801  
7802  /*
7803   * FILS discovery template minimum length with action frame headers and
7804   * mandatory fields.
7805   */
7806  #define NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_TMPL_MIN_LEN 42
7807  
7808  /**
7809   * enum nl80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_attributes - Unsolicited broadcast probe
7810   *	response configuration. Applicable only in 6GHz.
7811   *
7812   * @__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7813   *
7814   * @NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INT: Maximum packet interval (u32, TU).
7815   *	Allowed range: 0..20 (TU = Time Unit). IEEE P802.11ax/D6.0
7816   *	26.17.2.3.2 (AP behavior for fast passive scanning). If set to 0, the feature is
7817   *	disabled.
7818   * @NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_TMPL: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
7819   *	frame template (binary).
7820   *
7821   * @__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7822   * @NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute
7823   */
7824  enum nl80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_attributes {
7825  	__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
7826  
7827  	NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INT,
7828  	NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_TMPL,
7829  
7830  	/* keep last */
7831  	__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_LAST,
7832  	NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_MAX =
7833  		__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_LAST - 1
7834  };
7835  
7836  /**
7837   * enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism - The mechanism(s) allowed for SAE PWE
7838   *	derivation. Applicable only when WPA3-Personal SAE authentication is
7839   *	used.
7840   *
7841   * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED: not specified, used internally to indicate that
7842   *	attribute is not present from userspace.
7843   * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK: hunting-and-pecking loop only
7844   * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT: hash-to-element only
7845   * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH: both hunting-and-pecking loop and hash-to-element
7846   *	can be used.
7847   */
7848  enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism {
7849  	NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED,
7850  	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK,
7851  	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT,
7852  	NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH,
7853  };
7854  
7855  /**
7856   * enum nl80211_sar_type - type of SAR specs
7857   *
7858   * @NL80211_SAR_TYPE_POWER: power limitation specified in 0.25dBm unit
7859   *
7860   * @NUM_NL80211_SAR_TYPE: internal
7861   */
7862  enum nl80211_sar_type {
7863  	NL80211_SAR_TYPE_POWER,
7864  
7865  	/* add new type here */
7866  
7867  	/* Keep last */
7868  	NUM_NL80211_SAR_TYPE,
7869  };
7870  
7871  /**
7872   * enum nl80211_sar_attrs - Attributes for SAR spec
7873   *
7874   * @__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7875   *
7876   * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_TYPE: the SAR type as defined in &enum nl80211_sar_type.
7877   *
7878   * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS: Nested array of SAR power
7879   *	limit specifications. Each specification contains a set
7880   *	of %nl80211_sar_specs_attrs.
7881   *
7882   *	For SET operation, it contains array of %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER
7883   *	and %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_RANGE_INDEX.
7884   *
7885   *	For sar_capa dump, it contains array of
7886   *	%NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_START_FREQ
7887   *	and %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_END_FREQ.
7888   *
7889   * @__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7890   * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_MAX: highest sar attribute
7891   *
7892   * These attributes are used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPEC
7893   */
7894  enum nl80211_sar_attrs {
7895  	__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_INVALID,
7896  
7897  	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_TYPE,
7898  	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS,
7899  
7900  	__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_LAST,
7901  	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_SAR_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7902  };
7903  
7904  /**
7905   * enum nl80211_sar_specs_attrs - Attributes for SAR power limit specs
7906   *
7907   * @__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_INVALID: Invalid
7908   *
7909   * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER: Required (s32)value to specify the actual
7910   *	power limit value in units of 0.25 dBm if type is
7911   *	NL80211_SAR_TYPE_POWER. (i.e., a value of 44 represents 11 dBm).
7912   *	0 means userspace doesn't have SAR limitation on this associated range.
7913   *
7914   * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_RANGE_INDEX: Required (u32) value to specify the
7915   *	index of exported freq range table and the associated power limitation
7916   *	is applied to this range.
7917   *
7918   *	Userspace isn't required to set all the ranges advertised by WLAN driver,
7919   *	and userspace can skip some certain ranges. These skipped ranges don't
7920   *	have SAR limitations, and they are same as setting the
7921   *	%NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER to any unreasonable high value because any
7922   *	value higher than regulatory allowed value just means SAR power
7923   *	limitation is removed, but it's required to set at least one range.
7924   *	It's not allowed to set duplicated range in one SET operation.
7925   *
7926   *	Every SET operation overwrites previous SET operation.
7927   *
7928   * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_START_FREQ: Required (u32) value to specify the start
7929   *	frequency of this range edge when registering SAR capability to wiphy.
7930   *	It's not a channel center frequency. The unit is kHz.
7931   *
7932   * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_END_FREQ: Required (u32) value to specify the end
7933   *	frequency of this range edge when registering SAR capability to wiphy.
7934   *	It's not a channel center frequency. The unit is kHz.
7935   *
7936   * @__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_LAST: Internal
7937   * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_MAX: highest sar specs attribute
7938   */
7939  enum nl80211_sar_specs_attrs {
7940  	__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_INVALID,
7941  
7942  	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER,
7943  	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_RANGE_INDEX,
7944  	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_START_FREQ,
7945  	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_END_FREQ,
7946  
7947  	__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_LAST,
7948  	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_MAX = __NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_LAST - 1,
7949  };
7950  
7951  /**
7952   * enum nl80211_mbssid_config_attributes - multiple BSSID (MBSSID) and enhanced
7953   * multi-BSSID advertisements (EMA) in AP mode.
7954   * Kernel uses some of these attributes to advertise driver's support for
7955   * MBSSID and EMA.
7956   * Remaining attributes should be used by the userspace to configure the
7957   * features.
7958   *
7959   * @__NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7960   *
7961   * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_INTERFACES: Used by the kernel to advertise
7962   *	the maximum number of MBSSID interfaces supported by the driver.
7963   *	Driver should indicate MBSSID support by setting
7964   *	wiphy->mbssid_max_interfaces to a value more than or equal to 2.
7965   *
7966   * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_EMA_PROFILE_PERIODICITY: Used by the kernel
7967   *	to advertise the maximum profile periodicity supported by the driver
7968   *	if EMA is enabled. Driver should indicate EMA support to the userspace
7969   *	by setting wiphy->ema_max_profile_periodicity to
7970   *	a non-zero value.
7971   *
7972   * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INDEX: Mandatory parameter to pass the index of
7973   *	this BSS (u8) in the multiple BSSID set.
7974   *	Value must be set to 0 for the transmitting interface and non-zero for
7975   *	all non-transmitting interfaces. The userspace will be responsible
7976   *	for using unique indices for the interfaces.
7977   *	Range: 0 to wiphy->mbssid_max_interfaces-1.
7978   *
7979   * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_IFINDEX: Mandatory parameter for
7980   *	a non-transmitted profile which provides the interface index (u32) of
7981   *	the transmitted profile. The value must match one of the interface
7982   *	indices advertised by the kernel. Optional if the interface being set up
7983   *	is the transmitting one, however, if provided then the value must match
7984   *	the interface index of the same.
7985   *
7986   * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_EMA: Flag used to enable EMA AP feature.
7987   *	Setting this flag is permitted only if the driver advertises EMA support
7988   *	by setting wiphy->ema_max_profile_periodicity to non-zero.
7989   *
7990   * @__NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7991   * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute
7992   */
7993  enum nl80211_mbssid_config_attributes {
7994  	__NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INVALID,
7995  
7996  	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_INTERFACES,
7997  	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_EMA_PROFILE_PERIODICITY,
7998  	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INDEX,
7999  	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_IFINDEX,
8000  	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_EMA,
8001  
8002  	/* keep last */
8003  	__NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_LAST,
8004  	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_LAST - 1,
8005  };
8006  
8007  /**
8008   * enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags - AP settings flags
8009   *
8010   * @NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: AP supports external
8011   *	authentication.
8012   * @NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT: Userspace supports SA Query
8013   *	procedures offload to driver. If driver advertises
8014   *	%NL80211_AP_SME_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD in AP SME features, userspace shall
8015   *	ignore SA Query procedures and validations when this flag is set by
8016   *	userspace.
8017   */
8018  enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags {
8019  	NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT	= 1 << 0,
8020  	NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT	= 1 << 1,
8021  };
8022  
8023  /**
8024   * enum nl80211_wiphy_radio_attrs - wiphy radio attributes
8025   *
8026   * @__NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
8027   *
8028   * @NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_INDEX: Index of this radio (u32)
8029   * @NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE: Frequency range supported by this
8030   *	radio. Attribute may be present multiple times.
8031   * @NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATION: Supported interface
8032   *	combination for this radio. Attribute may be present multiple times
8033   *	and contains attributes defined in &enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs.
8034   *
8035   * @__NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_LAST: Internal
8036   * @NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_MAX: Highest attribute
8037   */
8038  enum nl80211_wiphy_radio_attrs {
8039  	__NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_INVALID,
8040  
8041  	NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_INDEX,
8042  	NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE,
8043  	NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATION,
8044  
8045  	/* keep last */
8046  	__NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_LAST,
8047  	NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_LAST - 1,
8048  };
8049  
8050  /**
8051   * enum nl80211_wiphy_radio_freq_range - wiphy radio frequency range
8052   *
8053   * @__NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
8054   *
8055   * @NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_START: Frequency range start (u32).
8056   *	The unit is kHz.
8057   * @NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_END: Frequency range end (u32).
8058   *	The unit is kHz.
8059   *
8060   * @__NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_LAST: Internal
8061   * @NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_MAX: Highest attribute
8062   */
8063  enum nl80211_wiphy_radio_freq_range {
8064  	__NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_INVALID,
8065  
8066  	NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_START,
8067  	NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_END,
8068  
8069  	__NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_LAST,
8070  	NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_LAST - 1,
8071  };
8072  
8073  #endif /* __LINUX_NL80211_H */
8074